0% found this document useful (0 votes)
570 views

Manual Juniper

Manual Juniper

Uploaded by

Andres Garcia
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
570 views

Manual Juniper

Manual Juniper

Uploaded by

Andres Garcia
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 242

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet

Switches

Published: 2014-07-30
Revision 16

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Juniper Networks, Inc.


1194 North Mathilda Avenue
Sunnyvale, California 94089
USA
408-745-2000
www.juniper.net
Juniper Networks, Junos, Steel-Belted Radius, NetScreen, and ScreenOS are registered trademarks of Juniper Networks, Inc. in the United
States and other countries. The Juniper Networks Logo, the Junos logo, and JunosE are trademarks of Juniper Networks, Inc. All other
trademarks, service marks, registered trademarks, or registered service marks are the property of their respective owners.
Juniper Networks assumes no responsibility for any inaccuracies in this document. Juniper Networks reserves the right to change, modify,
transfer, or otherwise revise this publication without notice.

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches


Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.
All rights reserved.
Revision History
July 2014Revision 16
June 2014Revision 15
April 2014Revision 14
March 2014Revision 13
January 2013Revision 12
September 2012Revision 11
September 2012Revision 10
March 2012Revision 9
November 2011Revision 8
September 2011Revision 7
July 2011Revision 6
March 2011Revision 5
December 2010Revision 4
August 2010Revision 3
May 2010Revision 2
February 2010Revision 1
The information in this document is current as of the date on the title page.
YEAR 2000 NOTICE
Juniper Networks hardware and software products are Year 2000 compliant. Junos OS has no known time-related limitations through the
year 2038. However, the NTP application is known to have some difficulty in the year 2036.
SOFTWARE LICENSE
The terms and conditions for using this software are described in the software license contained in the acknowledgment to your purchase
order or, to the extent applicable, to any reseller agreement or end-user purchase agreement executed between you and Juniper Networks.
By using this software, you indicate that you understand and agree to be bound by those terms and conditions.
Generally speaking, the software license restricts the manner in which you are permitted to use the software and may contain prohibitions
against certain uses. The software license may state conditions under which the license is automatically terminated. You should consult
the license for further details.
For complete product documentation, please see the Juniper Networks Web site at www.juniper.net/techpubs.

END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT


The Juniper Networks product that is the subject of this technical documentation consists of (or is intended for use with) Juniper Networks
software. Use of such software is subject to the terms and conditions of the End User License Agreement (EULA) posted at
http://www.juniper.net/support/eula.html. By downloading, installing or using such software, you agree to the terms and conditions of
that EULA.

ii

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Table of Contents
About the Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
Junos OS Documentation and Release Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
Documentation Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
Documentation Feedback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvii
Requesting Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xviii
Self-Help Online Tools and Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xviii
Opening a Case with JTAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xviii

Part 1

Switch and Components Overview and Specifications

Chapter 1

EX2200 Switch Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3


EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
EX2200 Switches First View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Uplink Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Console Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Cable Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Security Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Front Panel of an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Rear Panel of an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
EX2200 Switch Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Chassis Physical Specifications for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
EX2200 Switch Hardware and CLI Terminology Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

Chapter 2

Component Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Chassis Status LEDs in EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Network Port and Uplink Port LEDs in EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Management Port LEDs in EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Power Supply in EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Cooling System and Airflow in an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Airflow Direction in Non-PoE Models of EX2200 Switches, Except for the
EX2200-C Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Airflow Direction in PoE Models of EX2200 switches, Except for the
EX2200-C Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20

Chapter 3

Component Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
USB Port Specifications for an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Mini-USB Port Specifications for an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Network Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Console Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . 23

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

iii

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

RJ-45 to DB-9 Serial Port Adapter Pinout Information for an EX Series


Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . 25
Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26

Part 2

Planning for Switch Installation

Chapter 4

Site Preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Site Preparation Checklist for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
General Site Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Site Electrical Wiring Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Environmental Requirements and Specifications for EX Series Switches . . . . . . . 65

Chapter 5

Mounting and Clearance Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71


Rack Requirements for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Cabinet Requirements for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Requirements for Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desktop or Wall . . . . . . . . . . 73
Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200
Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74

Chapter 6

Cable Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Network Cable Specifications for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77

Chapter 7

Planning Power Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79


Power Specifications for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
AC Power Cord Specifications for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80

Part 3

Installing and Connecting the Switch and Switch Components

Chapter 8

Installing the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85


Installing and Connecting an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Unpacking an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Parts Inventory (Packing List) for an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Mounting an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desk or Other Level Surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Mounting an EX2200 Switch On or Under a Desk Using Screws . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet . . . . . 102
Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Wall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Mounting an EX2200 Switch Except the EX2200-C Model on a Wall . . . . . 102
Mounting an EX2200-C Switch on a Wall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Mounting an EX2200 Switch Using the Magnet Mount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109

Chapter 9

Installing Switch Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113


Installing a Transceiver in an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113

iv

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Table of Contents

Chapter 10

Connecting the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117


Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Parts and Tools Required for Connecting an EX Series Switch to Earth
Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Special Instructions to Follow Before Connecting Earth Ground to a
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band Management . . 127
Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Connecting an EX2200 Switch to a Management Console Using Mini-USB Type-B
Console Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Connecting a Fiber-Optic Cable to an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133

Chapter 11

Performing Initial Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135


EX2200 Switch Default Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) . . . . . . . . . 142

Part 4

Removing Switch Components

Chapter 12

Removing Switch Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149


Removing a Transceiver from an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Disconnecting a Fiber-Optic Cable from an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151

Part 5

Switch and Component Maintenance

Chapter 13

Routine Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155


Maintaining Fiber-Optic Cables in EX Series Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155

Part 6

Returning Hardware

Chapter 14

Returning the Switch or Switch Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159


Returning an EX2200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement . . . . . . 159
Locating the Serial Number on an EX2200 Switch or Component . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Listing the Switch and Components Details with the CLI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Locating the Chassis Serial Number ID Label on an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . 160
Contacting Customer Support to Obtain Return Materials Authorization for EX
Series Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Packing an EX2200 Switch or Component for Shipping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Packing a Switch for Shipping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Packing Switch Components for Shipping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164

Part 7

Safety Information

Chapter 15

General Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169


General Safety Guidelines and Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Definitions of Safety Warning Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Fire Safety Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Qualified Personnel Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173


Warning Statement for Norway and Sweden . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174

Chapter 16

Radiation and Laser Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175


Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches . . . . . . . 175
General Laser Safety Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Class 1 Laser Product Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Class 1 LED Product Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Laser Beam Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Radiation from Open Port Apertures Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178

Chapter 17

Installation and Maintenance Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181


Installation Instructions Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Ramp Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Wall-Mounting Warnings for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Grounded Equipment Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Maintenance and Operational Safety Guidelines and Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Battery Handling Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Jewelry Removal Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Lightning Activity Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Operating Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Product Disposal Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194

Chapter 18

Power and Electrical Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197


General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Prevention of Electrostatic Discharge Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
AC Power Disconnection Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
DC Power Disconnection Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
DC Power Grounding Requirements and Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
TN Power Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Action to Take After an Electrical Accident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212

Part 8

Compliance Information

Chapter 19

Compliance Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215


Agency Approvals for EX Series Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for EX Series Switches . . . . . . . 216
Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
European Community . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Israel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Japan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Korea . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
United States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
FCC Part 15 Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218

vi

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Table of Contents

Nonregulatory Environmental Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219


Compliance Statements for Acoustic Noise for EX Series Switches . . . . . . . . . . 219
Declaration of Conformity for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

vii

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

viii

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

List of Figures
Part 1

Switch and Components Overview and Specifications

Chapter 1

EX2200 Switch Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3


Figure 1: Front Panel of an EX2200 Switch with 48 Gigabit Ethernet Ports . . . . . . 6
Figure 2: Front Panel of an EX2200 Switch with 24 Gigabit Ethernet Ports . . . . . . 6
Figure 3: Front Panel of an EX2200-C Switch with 12 Gigabit Ethernet Ports
(PoE+) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Figure 4: Front Panel of an EX2200-C Switch with 12 Gigabit Ethernet Ports
(non-PoE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Figure 5: Rear Panel of an EX2200 Switch with AC Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Figure 6: Rear Panel of an EX2200-C-12P Switch with Heatsink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9

Chapter 2

Component Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Figure 7: Chassis Status LEDs in an EX2200 Switch Except the EX2200-C
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Figure 8: Chassis Status LEDs in an EX2200-C Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Figure 9: LEDs on the Network Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Figure 10: LEDs on the Uplink Ports and Port Status Mode LEDs in an EX2200
Switch Except the EX2200-C Switch Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Figure 11: Port Status Mode LEDs of the Dual-Purpose Uplink Ports of an
EX2200-C Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Figure 12: LEDs on the Management Port on an EX2200 Switch Except the
EX2200-C Switch Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Figure 13: LEDs on the Management Port on an EX2200-C Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Figure 14: Airflow Through Non-PoE Models of EX2200 Switches Except the
EX2200-C Switch Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Figure 15: Airflow Through PoE Models of EX2200 Switches Except the EX2200-C
Switch Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20

Part 2

Planning for Switch Installation

Chapter 5

Mounting and Clearance Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71


Figure 16: Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for
EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switch Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Figure 17: Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for
EX2200-C Switch Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Figure 18: Airflow Through PoE Models of EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C
Switch Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Figure 19: Airflow Through Non-PoE Models of EX2200 Switches Except
EX2200-C Switch Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76

Chapter 7

Planning Power Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

ix

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Figure 20: AC Plug Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81

Part 3

Installing and Connecting the Switch and Switch Components

Chapter 8

Installing the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85


Figure 21: Attaching Rubber Feet to a Switch Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Figure 22: Attaching a Cable Guard to an EX2200-C Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Figure 23: Securing the EX2200-C Switch Using Security Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Figure 24: Measurements for Installing Mounting Screws for EX2200-C
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Figure 25: Mounting the EX2200-C Switch On or Under a Desk Using Screws . . . 94
Figure 26: Attaching a Cable Guard to an EX2200-C Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Figure 27: Securing the EX2200-C Switch Using Security Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Figure 28: Attaching the Mounting Bracket Along the Front of the Switch . . . . . . 97
Figure 29: Mounting the Switch on Two Posts of a Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Figure 30: Attaching the Front-Mounting Bracket to the Side Mounting-Rail . . . 100
Figure 31: Attaching the Side Mounting-Rail to the Switch Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Figure 32: Mounting the Switch to the Front Posts of a Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Figure 33: Sliding the Rear Mounting-Blades into the Side Mounting-Rail . . . . . . 101
Figure 34: Attaching Wall-Mount Brackets to a Switch Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Figure 35: Measurements for Installing Mounting Screws . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Figure 36: Mounting the Switch on a Wall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Figure 37: Measurements for Installing Mounting Screws for the EX2200-C
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Figure 38: Mounting the EX2200-C Switch on a Wall Using Screws . . . . . . . . . . 108
Figure 39: Attaching a Cable Guard to an EX2200-C Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Figure 40: Securing the EX2200-C Switch Using Security Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Figure 41: Mounting an EX2200-C Switch Using Magnet Mount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Figure 42: Attaching a Cable Guard to an EX2200-C Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Figure 43: Securing the EX2200-C Switch Using Security Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112

Chapter 9

Installing Switch Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113


Figure 44: Installing a Transceiver in an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115

Chapter 10

Connecting the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117


Figure 45: Connecting the Grounding Lug to a Switch Mounted on Four Posts of
a Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Figure 46: Connecting a Grounding Cable to an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Figure 47: Connecting an AC Power Cord Retainer Clip to the AC Power Cord
Inlet on an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Figure 48: Connecting an AC Power Cord to the AC Power Cord Inlet on an
EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Figure 49: Securing Ring Lugs to the Terminals on the DC Power Supply . . . . . . 126
Figure 50: Ethernet Cable Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Figure 51: Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band
Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Figure 52: Ethernet Cable Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Figure 53: Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console Through
a Console Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

List of Figures

Figure 54: Connecting an EX Series Switch Directly to a Management


Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Figure 55: Connecting a Fiber-Optic Cable to an Optical Transceiver Installed in
an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133

Chapter 11

Performing Initial Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135


Figure 56: LCD Panel in an EX3200, EX4200, EX4500, EX4550, or EX8200
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Figure 57: LCD Panel in an EX4300 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143

Part 4

Removing Switch Components

Chapter 12

Removing Switch Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149


Figure 58: Removing a Transceiver from an EX Series Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151

Part 6

Returning Hardware

Chapter 14

Returning the Switch or Switch Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159


Figure 59: Location of the Serial Number ID Label on EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . 161

Part 7

Safety Information

Chapter 18

Power and Electrical Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197


Figure 60: Place a Component into an Antistatic Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

xi

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

xii

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

List of Tables
About the Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
Table 1: Notice Icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
Table 2: Text and Syntax Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi

Part 1

Switch and Components Overview and Specifications

Chapter 1

EX2200 Switch Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3


Table 3: EX2200 Switch Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Table 4: Physical Specifications of the EX2200 Switch Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Table 5: CLI Equivalents of Terms Used in Documentation for EX2200
Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

Chapter 2

Component Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Table 6: Chassis Status LEDs in an EX2200 Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Table 7: Link/Activity LED on the Network Ports and Uplink Ports in EX2200
Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Table 8: Status LED on the Network Ports, Uplink Ports, and Dual-Purpose Uplink
Ports in EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Table 9: Link/Activity LED on the Management Port on EX2200 Switches . . . . . . 17
Table 10: Status LED on the Management Port on EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . 18
Table 11: Power Consumed by EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18

Chapter 3

Component Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Table 12: Mini-USB Type-B Console Port Pinout Information for EX2200-C
Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Table 13: Network Port Connector Pinout Information for EX2200 Switches . . . . 23
Table 14: EX Series Switches Console Port Connector Pinout Information . . . . . . 24
Table 15: EX Series Switches RJ-45 to DB-9 Serial Port Adapter Pinout
Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Table 16: Management Port Connector Pinout Information for EX2200
Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit
Ethernet SFP Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C
Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Table 18: Optical Interface Support for Fast Ethernet SFP Transceivers in EX2200
Switches Except EX2200-C Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Table 19: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for SFP
Transceivers in EX2200-C Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52

Part 2

Planning for Switch Installation

Chapter 4

Site Preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

xiii

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 20: Site Preparation Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61


Table 21: Site Electrical Wiring Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Table 22: EX Series Switch Environmental Tolerances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66

Chapter 5

Mounting and Clearance Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71


Table 23: Rack Requirements and Specifications for the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Table 24: Cabinet Requirements and Specifications for the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . 73

Chapter 7

Planning Power Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79


Table 25: AC Power Supply Electrical Specifications for EX2200 Switches . . . . . 79
Table 26: DC Power Supply Electrical Specifications for EX2200 Switches . . . . . 79
Table 27: AC Power Cord Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80

Part 3

Installing and Connecting the Switch and Switch Components

Chapter 8

Installing the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85


Table 28: Parts List for EX2200 Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Table 29: EX2200 Switch Mounting Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88

Chapter 10

Connecting the Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117


Table 30: Parts and Tools Required for Connecting an EX Series Switch to Earth
Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Table 31: Special Instructions to Follow Before Connecting Earth Ground to a
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120

xiv

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

About the Documentation

Junos OS Documentation and Release Notes on page xv

Documentation Conventions on page xv

Documentation Feedback on page xvii

Requesting Technical Support on page xviii

Junos OS Documentation and Release Notes


For a list of related Junos OS documentation, see
http://www.juniper.net/techpubs/software/junos/.
If the information in the latest release notes differs from the information in the
documentation, follow the Junos OS Release Notes.

To obtain the most current version of all Juniper Networks technical documentation,
see the product documentation page on the Juniper Networks website at
http://www.juniper.net/techpubs/.

Documentation Conventions
Table 1 on page xvi defines the notice icons used in this guide.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

xv

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 1: Notice Icons


Icon

Meaning

Description

Informational note

Indicates important features or instructions.

Caution

Indicates a situation that might result in loss of data or hardware damage.

Warning

Alerts you to the risk of personal injury or death.

Laser warning

Alerts you to the risk of personal injury from a laser.

Tip

Indicates helpful information.

Best practice

Alerts you to a recommended use or implementation.

Table 2 on page xvi defines the text and syntax conventions used in this guide.

Table 2: Text and Syntax Conventions


Convention

Description

Examples

Bold text like this

Represents text that you type.

To enter configuration mode, type the


configure command:
user@host> configure

Fixed-width text like this

Italic text like this

Italic text like this

xvi

Represents output that appears on the


terminal screen.

user@host> show chassis alarms

Introduces or emphasizes important


new terms.

Identifies guide names.

A policy term is a named structure


that defines match conditions and
actions.

Identifies RFC and Internet draft titles.

Junos OS CLI User Guide

RFC 1997, BGP Communities Attribute

Represents variables (options for which


you substitute a value) in commands or
configuration statements.

No alarms currently active

Configure the machines domain name:


[edit]
root@# set system domain-name
domain-name

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

About the Documentation

Table 2: Text and Syntax Conventions (continued)


Convention

Description

Examples

Text like this

Represents names of configuration


statements, commands, files, and
directories; configuration hierarchy levels;
or labels on routing platform
components.

To configure a stub area, include the


stub statement at the [edit protocols
ospf area area-id] hierarchy level.

The console port is labeled CONSOLE.

< > (angle brackets)

Encloses optional keywords or variables.

stub <default-metric metric>;

| (pipe symbol)

Indicates a choice between the mutually


exclusive keywords or variables on either
side of the symbol. The set of choices is
often enclosed in parentheses for clarity.

broadcast | multicast

# (pound sign)

Indicates a comment specified on the


same line as the configuration statement
to which it applies.

rsvp { # Required for dynamic MPLS only

[ ] (square brackets)

Encloses a variable for which you can


substitute one or more values.

community name members [


community-ids ]

Indention and braces ( { } )

Identifies a level in the configuration


hierarchy.

; (semicolon)

Identifies a leaf statement at a


configuration hierarchy level.

(string1 | string2 | string3)

[edit]
routing-options {
static {
route default {
nexthop address;
retain;
}
}
}

GUI Conventions
Bold text like this

Represents graphical user interface (GUI)


items you click or select.

> (bold right angle bracket)

Separates levels in a hierarchy of menu


selections.

In the Logical Interfaces box, select


All Interfaces.

To cancel the configuration, click


Cancel.

In the configuration editor hierarchy,


select Protocols>Ospf.

Documentation Feedback
We encourage you to provide feedback, comments, and suggestions so that we can
improve the documentation. You can provide feedback by using either of the following
methods:

Online feedback rating systemOn any page at the Juniper Networks Technical
Documentation site at http://www.juniper.net/techpubs/index.html, simply click the
stars to rate the content, and use the pop-up form to provide us with information about
your experience. Alternately, you can use the online feedback form at
https://www.juniper.net/cgi-bin/docbugreport/.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

xvii

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

E-mailSend your comments to [email protected]. Include the document


or topic name, URL or page number, and software version (if applicable).

Requesting Technical Support


Technical product support is available through the Juniper Networks Technical Assistance
Center (JTAC). If you are a customer with an active J-Care or JNASC support contract,
or are covered under warranty, and need post-sales technical support, you can access
our tools and resources online or open a case with JTAC.

JTAC policiesFor a complete understanding of our JTAC procedures and policies,


review the JTAC User Guide located at
http://www.juniper.net/us/en/local/pdf/resource-guides/7100059-en.pdf.

Product warrantiesFor product warranty information, visit


http://www.juniper.net/support/warranty/.

JTAC hours of operationThe JTAC centers have resources available 24 hours a day,
7 days a week, 365 days a year.

Self-Help Online Tools and Resources


For quick and easy problem resolution, Juniper Networks has designed an online
self-service portal called the Customer Support Center (CSC) that provides you with the
following features:

Find CSC offerings: http://www.juniper.net/customers/support/

Search for known bugs: http://www2.juniper.net/kb/

Find product documentation: http://www.juniper.net/techpubs/

Find solutions and answer questions using our Knowledge Base: http://kb.juniper.net/

Download the latest versions of software and review release notes:


http://www.juniper.net/customers/csc/software/

Search technical bulletins for relevant hardware and software notifications:


http://kb.juniper.net/InfoCenter/

Join and participate in the Juniper Networks Community Forum:


http://www.juniper.net/company/communities/

Open a case online in the CSC Case Management tool: http://www.juniper.net/cm/

To verify service entitlement by product serial number, use our Serial Number Entitlement
(SNE) Tool: https://tools.juniper.net/SerialNumberEntitlementSearch/

Opening a Case with JTAC


You can open a case with JTAC on the Web or by telephone.

xviii

Use the Case Management tool in the CSC at http://www.juniper.net/cm/.

Call 1-888-314-JTAC (1-888-314-5822 toll-free in the USA, Canada, and Mexico).

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

About the Documentation

For international or direct-dial options in countries without toll-free numbers, see


http://www.juniper.net/support/requesting-support.html.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

xix

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

xx

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

PART 1

Switch and Components Overview and


Specifications

EX2200 Switch Overview on page 3

Component Descriptions on page 13

Component Specifications on page 21

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 1

EX2200 Switch Overview

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

EX2200 Switch Models on page 9

Chassis Physical Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 9

EX2200 Switch Hardware and CLI Terminology Mapping on page 10

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview


Juniper Networks EX Series Ethernet Switches provide scalable connectivity for the
enterprise market, including branch offices, campus locations, and data centers. The
switches run the Juniper Networks Junos operating system (Junos OS), which provides
Layer 2 and Layer 3 switching, routing, and security services. The same Junos OS code
base that runs on EX Series switches also runs on all Juniper Networks J Series, M Series,
MX Series, and T Series routers and SRX Series Services Gateways.
Juniper Networks EX2200 Ethernet Switches provide connectivity for low-density
environments.
This topic describes:

EX2200 Switches First View on page 3

Uplink Ports on page 4

Console Port on page 4

Cable Guard on page 5

Security Slots on page 5

Power over Ethernet (PoE) Ports on page 5

Front Panel of an EX2200 Switch on page 6

Rear Panel of an EX2200 Switch on page 7

EX2200 Switches First View


EX2200 switches are available in models with 12 , 24, or 48 built-in network ports. The
compact, fanless model, EX2200-C switches have 12 network ports.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

EX2200 switches provide:

Up to four uplink ports

12 (compact, fanless model), 24, or 48 built-in network ports with 10/100/100BASE-T


Gigabit Ethernet connectors

Virtual Chassis capabilityYou can connect up to four EX2200 switches (including


EX2200-C switches) together to form one unit that you manage as a single chassis,
called a Virtual Chassis, starting in Junos OS Release 12.2.

Power over Ethernet (PoE or PoE+) on all network ports (in PoE-capable models)

Uplink Ports
Each EX2200 switch except the EX2200-C switch model has four uplink ports that
support 1-gigabit small form-factor pluggable (SFP) transceivers for use with fiber
connections and copper connections.
Each EX2200-C switch has two dual-purpose uplink ports. Each dual uplink port consists
of an RJ-45 port (in which you can connect a copper Ethernet cable) and an SFP port
(into which you can plug a transceiver). Only one of the ports can be active at a time. By
default, if you connect a copper Ethernet cable to the RJ-45 port, this port becomes the
active port provided that there is no connection made on the other port. If you plug a
transceiver into the SFP port, this port becomes the active port whether or not a copper
Ethernet cable is connected to the other port. You can change this default behavior by
explicitly configuring a media typecopper or fiberfor the dual-purpose port using the
media-type command. For more information, see Configuring the Media Type on
Dual-Purpose Uplink Ports (CLI Procedure).
You can use an SFP uplink port connection between EX2200 switches to interconnect
the switches into an EX2200 Virtual Chassis. You must explicitly configure the SFP port
as a VCP. See Setting an Uplink Port on an EX Series Switch as a Virtual Chassis Port (CLI
Procedure).
For information about the supported optical and copper interfaces, see Pluggable
Transceivers Supported on EX2200 Switches on page 26.

Console Port
Each EX2200 switch except the EX2200-C switch model has an RJ-45 console port that
accepts a cable with RJ-45 connector.
The EX2200-C switch has two console ports: an RJ-45 port and a Mini-USB Type-B port.
The RJ-45 console port accepts a cable with an RJ-45 connector and the Mini-USB
Type-B console port accepts a Mini-B plug (5-pin) connector to connect to the console
management device. The switch activates only one console port at a time, either the
RJ-45 console port or the Mini USB type-B console port. By default, the RJ-45 port is the
active console port and the Mini-USB Type-B port is the passive console port. You can
change the default setting of a console port using the port-type command. See Configuring
the Console Port Type (CLI Procedure).

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 1: EX2200 Switch Overview

Cable Guard
On an EX2200-C switch model you can install a cable guard to secure the cables
connected to the switch. The cable guard has slots in the front of it through which you
can pass all the cables to prevent them from being accidently unplugged or removed
after they are connected. See Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desk or Other Level
Surface on page 89.

Security Slots
Each EX2200-C switch model has security slots on the left and right panels of the chassis.
The security slots allow you to lock and secure the chassis in the installation site using
a standard cable lock . See Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desk or Other Level Surface
on page 89.

Power over Ethernet (PoE) Ports


EX2200 switches are available in models with or without PoE/PoE+ capability. Models
that support PoE/PoE+ provide that support on all network ports. PoE ports provide
electrical current to devicessuch as IP phones, wireless access points, and security
camerasthrough network cables, thus eliminating the need for separate power cords
for those devices.
EX2200 switches with DC power supply do not provide PoE.

NOTE: Starting with Junos OS Release 12.2R1, PoE commands are enabled
on all non-PoE-capable EX2200 switch models. Also the PoE commands do
not provide any meaningful information on standalone non-PoE-capable
switch models. However, in an EX2200 Virtual Chassis, you can execute PoE
commands from a non-PoE-capable switch that is the master, to configure
PoE on PoE-capable Virtual Chassis members.

EX2200 switches running Junos OS Release 10.3 or later support powered devices that
comply with IEEE 802.3af (PoE) and IEEE 802.3at (PoE+).

NOTE: IEEE 802.3at class 4 powered devices require category 5 or higher


Ethernet cables.

EX2200 switches running Junos OS Release 10.2 or earlier support powered devices that
comply with IEEE 802.3af (PoE).
The remainder of this topic uses the term PoE to refer to both PoE and PoE+ unless there
is a need to distinguish between the two.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Front Panel of an EX2200 Switch


The front panel of an EX2200 switch except the EX2200-C switch models consists of
the following components:

Network portsdepending on the switch model, either of:

24 or 48 10/100/1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet ports, with Power over Ethernet


(PoE) not available in EX2200-24T, EX2200-24T-DC, and EX2200-48T models

24 or 48 10/100/1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet ports, with Power over Ethernet


(PoE) available in EX2200-24P and EX2200-48Pmodels

4 built-in SFP uplink ports. You can use these ports to forward network traffic or
configure them into Virtual Chassis ports (VCPs) to interconnect EX2200 switches
into a Virtual Chassis.

2 chassis status LEDs

4 port status mode LEDs

Mode button

Figure 1 on page 6 shows the front panel of an EX2200 switch with 48 Gigabit Ethernet
ports. Figure 2 on page 6 shows the front panel of an EX2200 switch with 24 Gigabit
Ethernet ports.

Figure 1: Front Panel of an EX2200 Switch with 48 Gigabit Ethernet Ports


Chassis
status
LEDs

10

11

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

21

22

23

24

25

26

27

28

29

30

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

44

45

46

47
S
SY

ALM

SPD
DX

EN

Port status mode LEDs

Network
ports

Mode
button

SFP
uplink
ports

g027000

POE

Figure 2: Front Panel of an EX2200 Switch with 24 Gigabit Ethernet Ports


Chassis
status
LEDs

10

11

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

21

22

23
S
SY

ALM

SPD
DX

EN

Port status mode LEDs

Network
ports

SFP
uplink
ports

Mode
button

g027002

POE

The front panel of an EX2200-C switch consists of the following components:

Network portsdepending on the switch model, either of:

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 1: EX2200 Switch Overview

12 10/100/1000BASE-T Ethernet ports, (non-PoE) in EX2200-C-12T

12 10/100/1000BASE-T Ethernet ports, (PoE+) in EX2200-C-12P

2 built-in dual-purpose uplink ports, each of which includes one 10/100/1000 RJ-45
Ethernet port and one SFP port

1 USB port

1 Mini-USB console port

1 RJ-45 console port

1 Management Ethernet port

2 chassis status LEDs

4 port status mode LEDs in PoE+ and 3 port status mode LEDs in non-PoE

Mode button

Figure 3 on page 7 shows the front panel of an EX2200-C switch with 12 Gigabit Ethernet
PoE+ ports and Figure 4 on page 7 shows the front panel of an EX2200-C switch with
12 Gigabit Ethernet non-PoE ports.

Figure 3: Front Panel of an EX2200-C Switch with 12 Gigabit Ethernet


Ports (PoE+)
Dual-purpose
uplink ports 0

Console
port

g021150

USB
port

Network ports

Dual-purpose
uplink ports 1

Management
port

Mini USB
port

g021151

Figure 4: Front Panel of an EX2200-C Switch with 12 Gigabit Ethernet


Ports (non-PoE)

Rear Panel of an EX2200 Switch


The rear panel of the EX2200 switch except the EX2200-C switch models consists of
the following components:

Management Ethernet port

USB port

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Console port

Protective earthing terminal

ESD point

Air exhaust

Serial number ID label

AC power cord inlet or DC power terminals

Figure 5 on page 8 shows the rear panel of an EX2200 switch with an AC power supply.
All EX2200 switches except the EX2200-C switch model have three exhaust openings
on the rear panel. The two exhaust openings on the left have fans behind them and are
open. The exhaust opening on the right is open on Power over Ethernet (PoE) models
and closed on non-PoE models. On PoE models, this opening exhausts the air from the
fan at the air intake for the power supply on the side panel.
The power cord retainer clips extend out of the chassis by 3 in.

Figure 5: Rear Panel of an EX2200 Switch with AC Power Supply


Management
Ethernet port

Protective
ESD
earthing terminal point

Air intake with fan for power supply


(fan on PoE models only)

EX2200-24-4G REV: X1
Mfg. Date
20090227

g027001

750-026464 REV: X3
MAC: 00:23:9C:oE:19:00

MADE IN CHINA

USB
port

Console
port

Air exhaust
with fan

Air exhaust without fan


Serial number
(closed on non-PoE models)
ID label

AC power
cord inlet

The rear panel of an EX2200-C switch consists of the following components:

Protective earthing terminal

ESD point

Serial number ID label

AC power cord inlet

Heatsink-only in PoE+ models

Figure 6 on page 9 shows the rear panel of an EX2200-C-12P switch with heatsink.
EX2200-C switches being fanless models have no exhaust openings. The switch has
vents on the top and on both the sides of the chassis. The PoE+ models have heatsink
installed in the rear panel to dissipate the heat, while non-PoE models have no heatsink.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 1: EX2200 Switch Overview

g021152

Figure 6: Rear Panel of an EX2200-C-12P Switch with Heatsink

Heatsink

Related
Documentation

EX2200 Switch Models on page 9

Site Preparation Checklist for EX2200 Switches on page 61

EX2200 Switch Models


The EX2200 switch is available with 12, 24, or 48 built-in network ports with full Power
over Ethernet (PoE) capability (all 12, 24, or 48 built-in network ports support PoE) or no
PoE capability. EX2200 switches with DC power supply do not provide PoE.
Table 3 on page 9 lists the EX2200 switch models.

Table 3: EX2200 Switch Models


Maximum PoE
Power pport
PoEAvailable

First Junos OS
Release

Model

Access Ports

Ports in Which PoE Is


Available

EX2200-C-12T-2G

12 Gigabit Ethernet

11.3R1

EX2200-C-12P-2G

12 Gigabit Ethernet

All 12 ports

100 W

11.3R1

EX2200-24T-4G

24 Gigabit Ethernet

10.1R1

EX2200-24P-4G

24 Gigabit Ethernet

All 24 ports

405 W

10.1R1

EX2200-24T-4G-DC

24 Gigabit Ethernet

10.1R1

EX2200-48T-4G

48 Gigabit Ethernet

10.1R1

EX2200-48P-4G

48 Gigabit Ethernet

All 48 ports

405 W

10.1R1

Related
Documentation

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Chassis Physical Specifications for EX2200 Switches


The EX2200 switch chassis is a rigid sheet-metal structure that houses the hardware
components. Table 4 on page 10 summarizes the physical specifications of the EX2200
switch chassis.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 4: Physical Specifications of the EX2200 Switch Chassis


Description

EX2200 Value

EX2200-C Value

Chassis height

1.75 in. (4.45 cm)

1.75 in. (4.4 cm)

Chassis width

17.5 in. (44.5 cm)

10.6 in. (26.92 cm)

19 in. (48.2 cm) with mounting brackets


attached

19 in. (48.26 cm) with mounting brackets

EX2200-C-12T: 9.0 in. (22.8 cm)

EX2200-C-12P: 9.4 in. (23.8 cm)

Chassis depth

Weight

10.5 in. (26.7 cm)

EX2200-24T: 6 lb (2.7 kg)

EX2200-C-12T: 4.6 lb (2.1 kg)

EX2200-24P: 8 lb (3.6 kg)

EX2200-C-12P: 6.4 lb (2.9 kg)

EX2200-24T-DC: 6 lb (2.7 kg)

EX2200-48T: 8 lb (3.6 kg)

EX2200-48P: 10 lb (4.5 kg)

Related
Documentation

Rack Requirements for EX2200 Switches on page 71

Cabinet Requirements for EX2200 Switches on page 72

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on page 88

Installing and Connecting an EX2200 Switch on page 85

EX2200 Switch Hardware and CLI Terminology Mapping


This topic describes the hardware terms used in EX2200 switch documentation and the
corresponding terms used in the Junos OS command line interface (CLI). See
Table 5 on page 10.

Table 5: CLI Equivalents of Terms Used in Documentation for EX2200 Switches


Hardware Item (as
displayed in the CLI)

Description (as
displayed in the CLI)

Value (as displayed


in the CLI)

Item in
Documentation

Additional
Information

Chassis

One of the following:

Switch chassis

Chassis Physical
Specifications for
EX2200 Switches on
page 9

10

EX2200-C-12T-2G

EX2200-C-12P-2G

EX2200-24T-4G

EX2200-24P-4G

EX2200-24T-4G-DC

EX2200-48T-4G

EX2200-48P-4G

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 1: EX2200 Switch Overview

Table 5: CLI Equivalents of Terms Used in Documentation for EX2200 Switches (continued)
Hardware Item (as
displayed in the CLI)

Description (as
displayed in the CLI)

Value (as displayed


in the CLI)

Item in
Documentation

Additional
Information

FPC (n)

Abbreviated name of
the Flexible PIC
Concentrator (FPC)

Value of n is always 0.

The switch does not


have actual FPCs. In
this case, FPC refers to
the switch itself.

Understanding Interface
Naming Conventions on
EX Series Switches

Abbreviated name of
the Physical Interface
Card (PIC)

n is a value in the range


of 01.

The switch does not


have actual PIC
devices; see entries for
PIC 0 through PIC 1 for
the equivalent item on
the switch.

Understanding Interface
Naming Conventions on
EX Series Switches

One of the following:

PIC 0

Built-in network ports


on the front panel of
the switch

EX2200 Switches
Hardware Overview
on page 3

PIC 1

Built-in uplink ports


and dual-purpose
uplink ports on the
front panel of the
switch

EX2200 Switches
Hardware Overview
on page 3

One of the following:

PIC (n)

EX2200-C-12T-2G

EX2200-C-12P-2G

EX2200-24T-4G

EX2200-24P-4G

EX2200-24T-4G-DC

EX2200-48T-4G

EX2200-48P-4G

12x 10/100/1000
BASE-T

24x 10/100/1000
BASE-T

48x 10/100/1000
BASE-T

One of the following:

2x (10/100/1000
BASE-T or GE SFP)
or

2x (100/1000
BASE-X)

4x GE SFP

Xcvr (n)

Abbreviated name of
the transceiver

n is a value equivalent
to the number of the
port in which the
transceiver is installed.

Optical transceivers

Pluggable
Transceivers
Supported on EX2200
Switches on page 26

Power supply (n)

Built-in power supply

Value of n is always 0.

AC power supply

Power Supply in
EX2200 Switches on
page 18

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

11

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 5: CLI Equivalents of Terms Used in Documentation for EX2200 Switches (continued)
Hardware Item (as
displayed in the CLI)

Description (as
displayed in the CLI)

Value (as displayed


in the CLI)

Item in
Documentation

Additional
Information

Fan

Fan

Fan

Cooling System and


Airflow in an EX2200
Switch on page 19

NOTE: EX2200-C
switches are fanless
models.

Related
Documentation

12

EX Series Switches Hardware and CLI Terminology Mapping

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 2

Component Descriptions

Chassis Status LEDs in EX2200 Switches on page 13

Network Port and Uplink Port LEDs in EX2200 Switches on page 14

Management Port LEDs in EX2200 Switches on page 17

Power Supply in EX2200 Switches on page 18

Cooling System and Airflow in an EX2200 Switch on page 19

Chassis Status LEDs in EX2200 Switches


The front panel of an EX2200 switch has two chassis status LEDs labeled SYS and ALM
on the far right side of the panel. See Figure 7 on page 13 and Figure 8 on page 13.

Figure 7: Chassis Status LEDs in an EX2200 Switch Except the EX2200-C


Switch
Chassis
status LEDs

S
SY

AL

SPD

EN
POE

g027003

DX

Figure 8: Chassis Status LEDs in an EX2200-C Switch

g021153

Chassis
status LEDs

Table 6 on page 14 describes the chassis status LEDs in an EX2200 switch, their colors
and states, and the status they indicate.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

13

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 6: Chassis Status LEDs in an EX2200 Switch


LED Label

Color

State and Description

SYS

Green

On steadilyThe switch is functioning normally.

BlinkingThe switch is booting.

OffThe switch is powered off or is halted.

ALM

Unlit

There is no alarm or the switch is halted.

Amber

There is a minor alarm.

Red

There is a major alarm.

A major alarm (red) indicates a critical error condition that requires immediate action.
A minor alarm (amber) indicates a noncritical condition that requires monitoring or
maintenance. A minor alarm that is left unchecked might cause interruption in service or
performance degradation.
Both LEDs can be lit simultaneously.
You can view the colors of the two LEDs remotely through the CLI by issuing the
operational mode command show chassis led.
Related
Documentation

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Checking Active Alarms with the J-Web Interface

Understanding Alarm Types and Severity Levels on EX Series Switches

Network Port and Uplink Port LEDs in EX2200 Switches


Each network port and uplink port on the front panel of an EX2200 switch has two LEDs
that indicate link/activity and port status. Each dual-purpose uplink port in an EX2200-C
switch has two pairs of LEDs that indicate the link/activity status, one pair for each of
the two ports that constitute the dual-purpose uplink port. See Figure 9 on page 14,
Figure 10 on page 15, and Figure 11 on page 15.

Figure 9: LEDs on the Network Port


Status

g041128

Link/
Activity

14

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 2: Component Descriptions

Figure 10: LEDs on the Uplink Ports and Port Status Mode LEDs in an
EX2200 Switch Except the EX2200-C Switch Model
Link/Activity
LED

Status
LED

Port status
mode LEDs

S
SY

AL

SPD
DX

EN
POE

Port 0

Port 1

Mode
Port 3 button

Port 2

g027007

Figure 11: Port Status Mode LEDs of the Dual-Purpose Uplink Ports of an
EX2200-C Switch

g021154

Port status mode LEDs

Dual-purpose
uplink ports

Table 7 on page 15 describes the Link/Activity LED.

Table 7: Link/Activity LED on the Network Ports and Uplink Ports in EX2200 Switches
LED

Color

State and Description

Link/Activity

Green

BlinkingThe port and the link are active, and there is link activity.

On steadilyThe port and the link are active, but there is no link activity.

OffThe port is not active.

In Figure 9 on page 14, Figure 10 on page 15, and Figure 11 on page 15 show the LEDs that
indicate the status of one of the four port parametersspeed, duplex mode, administrative
status, and Power over Ethernet (PoE) status. Use the mode button below the POE LED
on the far right side of the front panel to toggle the Status LED to show the different port
parameters. You can tell which port parameter is indicated by the Status LED by seeing
which port status mode LED (SPD, DX, EN, and POE) is lit. (See Figure 10 on page 15).
Table 8 on page 16 describes the Status LED.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

15

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 8: Status LED on the Network Ports, Uplink Ports, and Dual-Purpose Uplink Ports in
EX2200 Switches
Port Parameters

State and Description

Speed

Indicates the speed. The speed indicators for network ports are:

One blink per second10 Mbps

Two blinks per second100 Mbps

Three blinks per second1000 Mbps

The speed indicators for uplink ports are:

On steadily1000 Mbps

Off10/100 Mbps

The speed indicators for dual-purpose uplink ports of EX2200-C switch model are:

Duplex mode

Administrative status

PoE status

One blink per second10 Mbps

Two blinks per second100 Mbps

Three blinks per second1000 Mbps

Indicates the duplex mode. The status indicators are:

On steadilyPort is set to full-duplex mode.

OffPort is set to half-duplex mode.

Indicates the administrative status. The status indicators are:

On steadilyPort is administratively enabled.

OffPort is administratively disabled.

Indicates the PoE status. The status indicators for network ports are:

On steadilyPoE is available on the port, a device that draws power from the port
is connected to the port, and the device is drawing power from the port.

BlinkingPoE is available on the port, but no power is drawn from the port because
of one of the following:

No device that draws power from the port is connected to the port.

A device that draws power from the port is connected to the port, but the device
is not drawing any power from the port.

OffPoE is not available on the port.

NOTE: PoE Status LED is available on the following EX2200 switch models:

EX2200-C-12P-2G

EX2200-24P-4G

EX2200-48P-4G

PoE is not available on uplink ports; therefore, the LED for those ports is always unlit.

You can tell which port parameter is indicated by the Status LED on network ports, uplink
ports, and dual-purpose uplink ports by issuing the operational mode command show
chassis led.

16

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 2: Component Descriptions

Related
Documentation

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Configuring Gigabit Ethernet Interfaces (CLI Procedure)

Configuring Gigabit Ethernet Interfaces (J-Web Procedure)

Management Port LEDs in EX2200 Switches


The management port on an EX2200 switch has two LEDs that indicate link/activity and
port status. The EX2200 switches except the EX2200-C switch models have the
management port on the rear panel and the EX2200-C switch has the management port
on the front panel. See Figure 12 on page 17 and Figure 13 on page 17.

Figure 12: LEDs on the Management Port on an EX2200 Switch Except


the EX2200-C Switch Model

Status
LED

g027006

Link/Activity
LED

Figure 13: LEDs on the Management Port on an EX2200-C Switch

g021155

Link/Activity
LED

Status
LED

Table 9 on page 17 describes the Link/Activity LED.

Table 9: Link/Activity LED on the Management Port on EX2200 Switches


LED

Color

State and Description

Link/Activity

Green

BlinkingThe port and the link are active, and there is link
activity.

On steadilyThe port and the link are active, but there is no


link activity.

OffThe port is not active.

Table 10 on page 18 describes the Status LED.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

17

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 10: Status LED on the Management Port on EX2200 Switches


LED

Color

State and Description

Status

Green

Indicates the speed. The speed indicators are:

Related
Documentation

One blink per second10 Mbps

Two blinks per second100 Mbps

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 127

Power Supply in EX2200 Switches


The power supply in EX2200 switches is built in along the rear panel of the chassis, with
an AC power cord inlet or DC power terminals on the rear panel to connect power to the
switch.
Table 11 on page 18 lists the power consumed by each EX2200 switch model. The
maximum power available on a PoE port is 30 W for switches running Junos OS Release
10.3 or later and 15.4 W for switches running Junos OS Release 10.2 or earlier.

Table 11: Power Consumed by EX2200 Switches


Model Number

Number of PoE-Enabled
Ports

Maximum Power
Consumed by the Switch

Maximum PoE Power


Available

EX2200-C-12T

30 W

EX2200-C-12P

12

30 W (when no PoE power is


drawn)

100 W

EX2200-24T

50 W

EX2200-24P

24

60 W (when no PoE power is


drawn)

405 W

EX2200-24T-DC

50 W

EX2200-48T

76 W

EX2200-48P

48

91 W (when no PoE power is


drawn)

405 W

Related
Documentation

18

AC Power Cord Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 80

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Power Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 79

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 2: Component Descriptions

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch on page 117

Cooling System and Airflow in an EX2200 Switch


The cooling system in EX2200 switches, except EX2200-C, the compact, fanless models,
consists of two fans along the rear of the chassis that provide side-to-rear chassis cooling.
In the PoE models of these switches, there is an additional fan in the power supply.
In the EX2200-C switch the cooling is done by the vents on top and sides of the chassis
in non-PoE models and by heatsinks in PoE+ models. Do not block the vents on the
chassis. Doing this can lead to overheating of the switch chassis
This topic describes:

Airflow Direction in Non-PoE Models of EX2200 Switches, Except for the EX2200-C
Models on page 19

Airflow Direction in PoE Models of EX2200 switches, Except for the EX2200-C
Models on page 20

Airflow Direction in Non-PoE Models of EX2200 Switches, Except for the EX2200-C Models
Figure 14 on page 19 shows the airflow in non-PoE models of EX2200 switches, except
for the EX2200-C models.

Figure 14: Airflow Through Non-PoE Models of EX2200 Switches Except


the EX2200-C Switch Model

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

19

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Airflow Direction in PoE Models of EX2200 switches, Except for the EX2200-C Models
Figure 15 on page 20 shows the airflow in PoE models of EX2200 switches, except
EX2200-C models.

Figure 15: Airflow Through PoE Models of EX2200 Switches Except the
EX2200-C Switch Models

Under normal operating conditions, the fans operate at a moderate speed to reduce
noise. Temperature sensors in the chassis monitor the temperature within the chassis.
If any fan fails or if the temperature inside the chassis rises above the threshold, the
switch raises an alarm and all functioning fans operate at a higher speed than normal.
If the temperature inside the chassis rises above the threshold, the switch shuts down
automatically.
Related
Documentation

20

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Chassis Status LEDs in EX2200 Switches on page 13

Understanding Alarm Types and Severity Levels on EX Series Switches

Prevention of Electrostatic Discharge Damage on page 198

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 3

Component Specifications

USB Port Specifications for an EX Series Switch on page 21

Mini-USB Port Specifications for an EX2200 Switch on page 22

Network Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX2200 Switch on page 23

Console Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX Series Switch on page 23

RJ-45 to DB-9 Serial Port Adapter Pinout Information for an EX Series Switch on page 25

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX2200 Switch on page 25

Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX2200 Switches on page 26

USB Port Specifications for an EX Series Switch


The following Juniper Networks USB flash drives have been tested and are officially
supported for the USB port on all EX Series switches:

RE-USB-1G-S

RE-USB-2G-S

RE-USB-4G-S

CAUTION: Any USB memory product not listed as supported for EX Series
switches has not been tested by Juniper Networks. The use of any
unsupported USB memory product could expose your EX Series switch to
unpredictable behavior. Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center (JTAC)
can provide only limited support for issues related to unsupported hardware.
We strongly recommend that you use only supported USB flash drives.

All USB flash drives used on EX Series switches must have the following features:

USB 2.0 or later.

Formatted with a FAT or MS-DOS file system.

If the switch is running Junos OS Release 9.5 or earlier, the formatting method must
use a master boot record. Microsoft Windows formatting, by default, does not use a
master boot record. See the documentation for your USB flash drive for information
about how your USB flash drive is formatted.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

21

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Related
Documentation

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Rear Panel of an EX3200 Switch

Rear Panel of an EX3300 Switch

Rear Panel of an EX4200 Switch

EX4300 Switches Hardware Overview

Front Panel of an EX4500 Switch

Management Panel of an EX4600 Switch

EX4550 Switches Hardware Overview

Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX6200 Switch

Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX8208 Switch

Routing Engine (RE) Module in an EX8216 Switch

Routing Engine Module in an EX9200 Switch

Booting an EX Series Switch Using a Software Package Stored on a USB Flash Drive

Mini-USB Port Specifications for an EX2200 Switch


The EX2200-C switch, the compact, fanless model, has two management console ports:
an RJ-45 port, and a Mini-USB Type-B port.
By default, the RJ-45 port is set as the active console port. It can display all the early boot
and low-level message output and you can access the switch through this port in the
debugger prompt. The Mini-USB Type-B port is the passive console port. You can change
the status of the port to active or passive using the port-type configuration statement.
See Configuring the Console Port Type (CLI Procedure).).
The Mini-USB Type-B console port uses a Mini-B plug (5-pin) connector to connect to
a console management device. The default baud rate for the console port is 9600 baud.
Table 12 on page 22 provides the pinout information of the Mini-USB Type-B console
port.

Table 12: Mini-USB Type-B Console Port Pinout Information for EX2200-C Switches
Pin

Signal

Description

VCC

+5 VDC

D-

Data -

D+

Data +

N/C

May be N/C, GND or used as an attached device presence indicator

GND

Ground

22

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Related
Documentation

See EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3 for port location.

Configuring the Console Port Type (CLI Procedure)

Network Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX2200 Switch


A network port on an EX2200 switch uses an RJ-45 connector to connect to a device.
The port uses an autosensing RJ-45 connector to support a 10/100/1000Base-T
connection. Two LEDs on the port indicate link/activity on the port and the port status.
See Network Port and Uplink Port LEDs in EX2200 Switches on page 14.
Table 13 on page 23 provides the pinout information for the RJ-45 connector. An RJ-45
cable, with a connector attached, is supplied with the switch.

Table 13: Network Port Connector Pinout Information for EX2200 Switches
Pin

Signal

Description

TRP1+

Transmit/receive data pair 1


Negative Vport (in PoE models)

TRP1-

Transmit/receive data pair 1


Negative Vport (in PoE models)

TRP2+

Transmit/receive data pair 2


Positive Vport (in PoE models)

TRP3+

Transmit/receive data pair 3

TRP3-

Transmit/receive data pair 3

TRP2-

Transmit/receive data pair 2


Positive Vport (in PoE models)

TRP4+

Transmit/receive data pair 4

TRP4-

Transmit/receive data pair 4

Related
Documentation

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Console Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX Series Switch


The console port on an EX Series switch is an RS-232 serial interface that uses an RJ-45
connector to connect to a console management device. The default baud rate for the
console port is 9600 baud.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

23

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 14 on page 24 provides the pinout information for the RJ-45 console connector.
An RJ-45 cable and an RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port adapter are supplied with the switch.

NOTE: If your laptop or PC does not have a DB-9 male connector pin and you
want to connect your laptop or PC directly to an EX Series switch, use a
combination of the RJ-45 to DB-9 female adapter supplied with the switch
and a USB to DB-9 male adapter. You must provide the USB to DB-9 male
adapter.

Table 14: EX Series Switches Console Port Connector Pinout Information


Pin

Signal

Description

RTS Output

Request to send

DTR Output

Data terminal ready

TxD Output

Transmit data

Signal Ground

Signal ground

Signal Ground

Signal ground

RxD Input

Receive data

CD Input

Data carrier detect

CTS Input

Clear to send

Related
Documentation

24

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Rear Panel of an EX3200 Switch

Rear Panel of an EX3300 Switch

Rear Panel of an EX4200 Switch

EX4300 Switches Hardware Overview

Front Panel of an EX4500 Switch

EX4550 Switches Hardware Overview

Management Panel of an EX4600 Switch

Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX6200 Switch

Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX8208 Switch

Routing Engine (RE) Module in an EX8216 Switch

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console on page 129

Configuring the Console Port Type (CLI Procedure)

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

RJ-45 to DB-9 Serial Port Adapter Pinout Information for an EX Series Switch
The console port on an EX Series switch is an RS-232 serial interface that uses an RJ-45
connector to connect to a management device such as a PC or a laptop. If your laptop
or PC does not have a DB-9 male connector pin and you want to connect your laptop or
PC to an EX Series switch, use a combination of the RJ-45 to DB-9 female adapter
supplied with the switch along with a USB to DB-9 male adapter.
Table 15 on page 25 provides the pinout information for the RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port
adapter.

Table 15: EX Series Switches RJ-45 to DB-9 Serial Port Adapter Pinout
Information

Related
Documentation

RJ-45 Pin

Signal

DB-9 Pin

Signal

RTS

CTS

DTR

DSR

TXD

RXD

GND

GND

RXD

TXD

DSR

DTR

CTS

RTS

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console on page 129

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting an EX9200 Switch to a Management Console or an Auxiliary Device

Connecting and Configuring an EX9200 Switch (CLI Procedure)

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX2200 Switch


The management port on an EX2200 switch uses an RJ-45 connector to connect to a
management device for out-of-band management.
The port uses an autosensing RJ-45 connector to support a 10/100Base-T connection.
Two LEDs on the port indicate link/activity on the port and the administrative status of
the port. See Management Port LEDs in EX2200 Switches on page 17.
Table 16 on page 26 provides the pinout information for the RJ-45 connector for the
management port. An RJ-45 cable, with a connector attached, is supplied with the switch.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

25

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 16: Management Port Connector Pinout Information for EX2200 Switches
Pin

Signal

Description

TRP1+

Transmit/receive data pair 1

TRP1-

Transmit/receive data pair 1

TRP2+

Transmit/receive data pair 2

TRP2-

Transmit/receive data pair 2

Related
Documentation

See EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3 for port location.

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 127

Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX2200 Switches


Uplink ports and dual-purpose uplink ports on the front panel in EX2200 switches support
SFP transceivers. This topic describes the optical interfaces supported for those
transceivers. It also lists the copper interface supported for the SFP transceivers.

NOTE: Use only optical transceivers and optical connectors purchased from
Juniper Networks for your EX Series switches.

NOTE: EX2200-C switches ensure normal operation in the temperature range


30 F (0 C) through 104 F (40 C) at altitudes up to 1,524 m (5,000 ft).
In the following conditions, use extended temperature range SFPs when fiber
uplinks are used:

In the temperature range 104 F through 113 F (40 C up to 45 C) at


altitudes up to 1,524 m (5,000 ft)

In the temperature range 95 F through 113 F (35 C up to 45 C) at


altitudes above 1,524 m (5,000 ft) up to 3,048 m (10,000 ft)

The tables in this topic describe the optical interface support over single-mode fiber-optic
(SMF) and multimode fiber-optic (MMF) cables and over the copper interface for SFP
transceivers:

26

Table 17 on page 27Optical interface support and copper interface support for Gigabit
Ethernet SFP transceivers in EX2200 switches except EX2200-C switches.

Table 18 on page 46Optical interface support for Fast Ethernet SFP transceivers
except EX2200-C switches.

Table 19 on page 52Optical interface support and copper interface support for SFP
transceivers in EX2200-C switches.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-T

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-T

Rate

10/100/1000 Mbps

Connector Type

RJ-45

Transmitter Wavelength

Minimum Launch Power

Maximum Launch Power

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

Maximum Input Power

Core/Cladding Size

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

100 m (328 ft)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 10.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes, starting with Junos OS Release 12.3R3

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

27

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-SX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-SX

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

850 nm

Minimum Launch Power

9.5 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

3 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

21 dBm

Maximum Input Power

0 dBm

Fiber Type

MMF

Core/Cladding Size

62.5/125 m

62.5/125 m

50/125 m

50/125 m

Fiber Grade

FDDI

OM1

OM2

Modal Bandwidth

160 MHz/km

200 MHz/km

400 MHz/km

500 MHz/km

Distance

220 m
(722 ft)

275 m
(902 ft)

500 m
(1640 ft)

550 m
(1804 ft)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 10.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

28

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-LX

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

9.5 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

3 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

25 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

10 km (6.2 miles)

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

29

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-BX-U

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE10KT13R14

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Receiver Wavelength

1490 nm

Minimum Launch Power

9 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

3 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

30 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

10 km (6.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

30

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-BX-D

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE10KT14R13

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1490 nm

Receiver Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

9 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

3 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

30 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

10 km (6.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

31

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-BX-U

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE10KT13R15

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Receiver Wavelength

1550 nm

Minimum Launch Power

9 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

3 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

21 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

10 km (6.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

32

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-BX-D

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE10KT15R13

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1550 nm

Receiver Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

9 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

3 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

21 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

10 km (6.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

33

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-BX-U

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE40KT13R15

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Receiver Wavelength

1550 nm

Minimum Launch Power

6.5 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

2 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

23 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

40 km (24.8 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

34

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-BX-D

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE40KT15R13

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1550 nm

Receiver Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

6.5 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

2 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

23 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

40 km (24.8 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

35

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-LX40K

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Double

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

14 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

8 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

45 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

40 km (24.8 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

36

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LH (or
1000BASE-ZX)

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-LH

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1550 nm

Minimum Launch Power

2 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

25 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

70 km (43.5 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 10.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

37

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE80KCW1470

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1470 nm

Minimum Launch Power

0 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

DOM Support

Available

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 12.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

38

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE80KCW1490

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1490 nm

Minimum Launch Power

0 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

DOM Support

Available

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 12.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

39

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE80KCW1510

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1510 nm

Minimum Launch Power

0 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

DOM Support

Available

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 12.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

40

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE80KCW1530

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1530 nm

Minimum Launch Power

0 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

DOM Support

Available

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 12.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

41

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE80KCW1550

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1550 nm

Minimum Launch Power

0 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

DOM Support

Available

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 12.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

42

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE80KCW1570

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1570 nm

Minimum Launch Power

0 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

DOM Support

Available

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 12.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

43

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE80KCW1590

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1590 nm

Minimum Launch Power

0 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

DOM Support

Available

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 12.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

44

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 17: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for Gigabit Ethernet SFP
Transceivers in EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-GE80KCW1610

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1610 nm

Minimum Launch Power

0 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

DOM Support

Available

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 12.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

45

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 18: Optical Interface Support for Fast Ethernet SFP Transceivers in EX2200 Switches
Except EX2200-C Switches
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

100BASE-FX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1FE-FX

Rate

100 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

20 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

14 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32.5 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

MMF

Core/Cladding Size

62.5/125 m

Fiber Grade

FDDI/OM1

Modal Bandwidth

500 MHz/km

Distance

2 km (1.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 10.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

No

46

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 18: Optical Interface Support for Fast Ethernet SFP Transceivers in EX2200 Switches
Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

100BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1FE-LX

Rate

100 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

15 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

8 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

31.5 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

10 km (6.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

No

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

47

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 18: Optical Interface Support for Fast Ethernet SFP Transceivers in EX2200 Switches
Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

100BASE-BX-U

Model Number

EX-SFP-FE20KT13R15

Rate

100 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Receiver Wavelength

1550 nm

Minimum Launch Power

14 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

8 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

45 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

20 km (12.4 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 10.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

No

48

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 18: Optical Interface Support for Fast Ethernet SFP Transceivers in EX2200 Switches
Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

100BASE-BX-D

Model Number

EX-SFP-FE20KT15R13

Rate

100 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Single

Transmitter Wavelength

1550 nm

Receiver Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

14 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

8 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

45 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

20 km (12.4 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 10.1 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

No

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

49

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 18: Optical Interface Support for Fast Ethernet SFP Transceivers in EX2200 Switches
Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

100BASE-LX40K

Model Number

EX-SFP-1FE-LX40K

Rate

100 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

5 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

0 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

40 km (24.8 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

No

50

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 18: Optical Interface Support for Fast Ethernet SFP Transceivers in EX2200 Switches
Except EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

100BASE-LH (or
100BASE-ZX)

Model Number

EX-SFP-1FE-LH

Rate

100 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

5 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

0 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

80 km (49.7 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.2 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

No

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

51

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 19: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for SFP Transceivers in
EX2200-C Switches
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-SX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-SX

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

850 nm

Minimum Launch Power

9.5 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

3 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

21 dBm

Maximum Input Power

0 dBm

Fiber Type

MMF

Core/Cladding Size

62.5/125 m

62.5/125 m

50/125 m

50/125 m

Fiber Grade

FDDI

OM1

OM2

Modal Bandwidth

160 MHz/km

200 MHz/km

400 MHz/km

500 MHz/km

Distance

220 m
(722 ft)

275 m
(902 ft)

500 m
(1640 ft)

550 m
(1804 ft)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.3 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

52

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 19: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for SFP Transceivers in
EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

Extended Temp SFP


1000BASE-SX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-SX-EX

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Transmitter Wavelength

Minimum Launch Power

Maximum Launch Power

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

Maximum Input Power

Fiber Type

MMF

Core/Cladding Size

Modal Bandwidth

Transmitter Wavelength

850 nm

Distance

550 m (1804 ft)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.3 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

53

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 19: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for SFP Transceivers in
EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

Extended Temp SFP


100BASE-FX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1FE-FX-EX

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Transmitter Wavelength

Minimum Launch Power

Maximum Launch Power

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

Maximum Input Power

Fiber Type

MMF

Core/Cladding Size

Modal Bandwidth

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Distance

2 km (1.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.3 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

54

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 19: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for SFP Transceivers in
EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

100BASE-FX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1FE-FX

Rate

100 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

20 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

14 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

32.5 dBm

Maximum Input Power

8 dBm

Fiber Type

MMF

Core/Cladding Size

62.5/125 m

Fiber Grade

FDDI/OM1

Modal Bandwidth

500 MHz/km

Distance

2 km (1.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.3 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

55

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 19: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for SFP Transceivers in
EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LX

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-LX

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1310 nm

Minimum Launch Power

9.5 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

3 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

25 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

10 km (6.2 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.3 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

56

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 3: Component Specifications

Table 19: Optical Interface Support and Copper Interface Support for SFP Transceivers in
EX2200-C Switches (continued)
Ethernet Standard

Specification

Value

1000BASE-LH (or
1000BASE-ZX)

Model Number

EX-SFP-1GE-LH

Rate

1000 Mbps

Connector Type

LC

Fiber Count

Dual

Transmitter Wavelength

1550 nm

Minimum Launch Power

2 dBm

Maximum Launch Power

5 dBm

Minimum Receiver Sensitivity

25 dBm

Maximum Input Power

3 dBm

Fiber Type

SMF

Core/Cladding Size

9/125 m

Modal Bandwidth

Distance

70 km (43.5 miles)

Software Required

Junos OS for EX Series switches, Release 11.3 or later

Support for Virtual Chassis


Configuration

Yes

Related
Documentation

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Installing a Transceiver in an EX Series Switch on page 113

Removing a Transceiver from an EX Series Switch on page 149

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

57

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

58

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

PART 2

Planning for Switch Installation

Site Preparation on page 61

Mounting and Clearance Requirements on page 71

Cable Specifications on page 77

Planning Power Requirements on page 79

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

59

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

60

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 4

Site Preparation

Site Preparation Checklist for EX2200 Switches on page 61

General Site Guidelines on page 62

Site Electrical Wiring Guidelines on page 63

Environmental Requirements and Specifications for EX Series Switches on page 65

Site Preparation Checklist for EX2200 Switches


The checklist in Table 20 on page 61 summarizes the tasks you need to perform when
preparing a site for EX2200 switch installation.

Table 20: Site Preparation Checklist


Item or Task

For More Information

Performed by

Date

Environment
Verify that environmental factors such as
temperature and humidity do not exceed switch
tolerances.

Environmental Requirements and


Specifications for EX Series Switches
on page 65

Power
Measure distance between external power
sources and switch installation site.
Locate sites for connection of system
grounding.
Calculate the power consumption and
requirements.

Power Specifications for EX2200


Switches on page 79

Hardware Configuration
Choose the number and types of switches you
want to install.

EX2200 Switches Hardware


Overview on page 3

Rack or Cabinet

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

61

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 20: Site Preparation Checklist (continued)


Item or Task

For More Information

Verify that your rack or cabinet meets the


minimum requirements for the installation of
the switch.

Rack Requirements for EX2200


Switches on page 71

Performed by

Date

Cabinet Requirements for EX2200


Switches on page 72
Plan rack or cabinet location, including required
space clearances.

Clearance Requirements for Airflow


and Hardware Maintenance for
EX2200 Switches on page 74

Secure the rack or cabinet to the floor and


building structure.

Wall
Verify that the wall meets the minimum
requirements for the installation of the switch.

Requirements for Mounting an


EX2200 Switch on a Desktop or Wall
on page 73

Verify that there is appropriate clearance in your


selected location.

Clearance Requirements for Airflow


and Hardware Maintenance for
EX2200 Switches on page 74

Cables
Acquire cables and connectors:

Determine the number of cables needed


based on your planned configuration.

Review the maximum distance allowed for


each cable. Choose the length of cable based
on the distance between the hardware
components being connected.

Plan the cable routing and management.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Site Guidelines on page 62

Installing and Connecting an EX2200 Switch on page 85

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on page 88

General Site Guidelines


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

62

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 4: Site Preparation

Efficient device operation requires proper site planning and maintenance and proper
layout of the equipment, rack or cabinet (if used), and wiring closet.
To plan and create an acceptable operating environment for your device and prevent
environmentally caused equipment failures:

Related
Documentation

Keep the area around the chassis free from dust and conductive material, such as
metal flakes.

Follow prescribed airflow guidelines to ensure that the cooling system functions properly
and that exhaust from other equipment does not blow into the intake vents of the
device.

Follow the prescribed electrostatic discharge (ESD) prevention procedures to prevent


damaging the equipment. Static discharge can cause components to fail completely
or intermittently over time.

Install the device in a secure area, so that only authorized personnel can access the
device.

Prevention of Electrostatic Discharge Damage on page 198

Environmental Requirements and Specifications for EX Series Switches on page 65

Environmental Requirements and Specifications for a QFX3100 Director Device

Environmental Requirements and Specifications for a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device

Environmental Requirements and Specifications for a QFX3500 Device

Environmental Requirements and Specifications for QFX3600 and QFX3600-I Devices

Environmental Requirements and Specifications for a QFX5100 Switch

Site Electrical Wiring Guidelines


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.
Table 21 on page 64 describes the factors you must consider while planning the electrical
wiring at your site.

WARNING: It is particularly important to provide a properly grounded and


shielded environment and to use electrical surge-suppression devices.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

63

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 21: Site Electrical Wiring Guidelines


Site Wiring Factor

Guidelines

Signaling limitations

If your site experiences any of the following problems, consult experts in


electrical surge suppression and shielding:

Radio frequency
interference

Electromagnetic
compatibility

Improperly installed wires cause radio frequency interference (RFI).

Damage from lightning strikes occurs when wires exceed recommended


distances or pass between buildings.

Electromagnetic pulses (EMPs) caused by lightning damage unshielded


conductors and electronic devices.

To reduce or eliminate radio frequency interference (RFI) from your site


wiring, do the following:

Use a twisted-pair cable with a good distribution of grounding


conductors.

If you must exceed the recommended distances, use a high-quality


twisted-pair cable with one ground conductor for each data signal when
applicable.

If your site is susceptible to problems with electromagnetic compatibility


(EMC), particularly from lightning or radio transmitters, seek expert advice.
Some of the problems caused by strong sources of electromagnetic
interference (EMI) are:

Related
Documentation

64

Destruction of the signal drivers and receivers in the switch

Electrical hazards as a result of power surges conducted over the lines


into the equipment

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

Prevention of Electrostatic Discharge Damage on page 198

Power Supply in EX2200 Switches on page 18

Power Supply in EX3200 Switches

Power Supply in EX3300 Switches

Power Supply in EX4200 Switches

AC Power Supply in EX4300 Switches

DC Power Supply in EX4300 Switches

AC Power Supply in EX4500 Switches

DC Power Supply in EX4500 Switches

AC Power Supply in EX4550 Switches

DC Power Supply in EX4550 Switches

AC Power Supply in an EX4600 Switch

DC Power Supply in an EX4600 Switch

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 4: Site Preparation

AC Power Supplies in an EX6200 Switch

DC Power Supply in an EX6200 Switch

AC Power Supply in an EX8200 Switch

DC Power Supply in an EX8200 Switch

AC Power Supply in an EX9204 Switch

DC Power Supply in an EX9204 Switch

AC Power Supply in an EX9208 Switch

DC Power Supply in an EX9208 Switch

AC Power Supply in an EX9214 Switch

DC Power Supply in an EX9214 Switch

Power Supply in an EX Series Redundant Power System

AC Power Supply in a QFX3100 Director Device

AC Power Supply in a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device

Wiring Tray in a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device

AC Power Supply for a QFX3500, QFX3600, or QFX3600-I Device

DC Power Supply for a QFX3500, QFX3600, or QFX3600-I Device

AC Power Supply for a QFX5100 Switch

DC Power Supply in a QFX5100 Switch Devices

Environmental Requirements and Specifications for EX Series Switches


The switch must be installed in a rack or cabinet housed in a dry, clean, well-ventilated,
and temperature-controlled environment.
Ensure that these environmental guidelines are followed:

The site must be as dust-free as possible, because dust can clog air intake vents and
filters, reducing the efficiency of the switch cooling system.

Maintain ambient airflow for normal switch operation. If the airflow is blocked or
restricted, or if the intake air is too warm, the switch might overheat, leading to the
switch temperature monitor shutting down the switch to protect the hardware
components.

Table 22 on page 66 provides the required environmental conditions for normal switch
operation.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

65

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 22: EX Series Switch Environmental Tolerances


Environment Tolerance
Switch or
device
EX2200-C

Altitude

Relative Humidity

Temperature

Seismic

No performance
degradation up to
5,000 feet
(1524 meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
104 F (0 C through 40 C) at
altitudes up to 5,000 ft
(1,524 m).

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

For information about extended


temperature SFPs, see
Pluggable Transceivers
Supported on EX2200 Switches
on page 26.
EX2200
(except
EX2200-C
switches)

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
113 F (0 C through 45 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX3200

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
113 F (0 C through 45 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX3300

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
113 F (0 C through 45 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX4200

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
113 F (0 C through 45 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX4300

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
113 F (0 C through 45 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX4500

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
113 F (0 C through 45 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

66

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 4: Site Preparation

Table 22: EX Series Switch Environmental Tolerances (continued)


Environment Tolerance
Switch or
device
EX4550

EX4600

Altitude

Relative Humidity

Temperature

Seismic

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

EX4550-32F
switchesNormal operation
ensured in the temperature
range 32 F through 113 F (0
C through 45 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX4550-32T
switchesNormal operation
is ensured in the temperature
range 32 F through 104 F
(0 C through 40 C)

Normal operation ensured in


temperature range of 32 F
through 104 F (0 C through
40 C)

Nonoperating storage
temperature in shipping
container: 40 F through
158 F (40 C through 70 C)

No performance
degradation to
6,562 feet
(2000 meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
5% through 90%,
noncondensing

Short-term operation
ensured in relative
humidity range of 5%
through 93%,
noncondensing

Designed to comply
with Zone 4
earthquake
requirements per
NEBS GR-63-CORE,
Issue 3.

NOTE: As defined in
NEBS GR-63-CORE, Issue
3, short-term events can
be up to 96 hours in
duration but not more
than 15 days per year.

EX6210

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
104 F (0 C through 40 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX8208

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
104 F (0 C through 40 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX8216

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet
(3048 meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
104 F (0 C through 40 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

EX9204

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
5% through 90%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
104 F (0 C through 40 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63.

Nonoperating storage
temperature in shipping
container: 40 F (40 C) to
158 F (70 C)

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

67

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 22: EX Series Switch Environmental Tolerances (continued)


Environment Tolerance
Switch or
device
EX9208

Altitude

Relative Humidity

Temperature

Seismic

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
5% through 90%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
104 F (0 C through 40 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63.

Nonoperating storage
temperature in shipping
container: 40 F (40 C) to
158 F (70 C)
EX9214

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
5% through 90%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 32 F through
104 F (0 C through 40 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63.

Nonoperating storage
temperature in shipping
container: 40 F (40 C) to
158 F (70 C)
XRE200

No performance
degradation up to
10,000 feet (3048
meters)

Normal operation ensured


in relative humidity range of
10% through 85%
(noncondensing)

Normal operation ensured in the


temperature range 41 F through
104 F (5 C through 40 C)

Complies with Zone 4


earthquake
requirements as per
GR-63, Issue 3.

NOTE: Install EX Series switches only in restricted areas, such as dedicated


equipment rooms and equipment closets, in accordance with Articles 11016,
11017, and 11018 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70.

Related
Documentation

68

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200 Switches
on page 74

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX3200 Switches

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX3300 Switches

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX4200 Switches

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX4300 Switches

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for an EX4600 Switch

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for an EX Series


Redundant Power System

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX4500 Switches

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX4550 Switches

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for an EX6210 Switch

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for an EX8208 Switch

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 4: Site Preparation

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for an EX8216 Switch

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for an EX9204 Switch

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for an EX9208 Switch

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for an EX9214 Switch

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

69

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

70

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 5

Mounting and Clearance Requirements

Rack Requirements for EX2200 Switches on page 71

Cabinet Requirements for EX2200 Switches on page 72

Requirements for Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desktop or Wall on page 73

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200


Switches on page 74

Rack Requirements for EX2200 Switches


You can mount the EX2200 switches on two-post racks or four-post racks.
Rack requirements consist of:

Rack type

Mounting bracket hole spacing

Rack size and strength

Rack connection to the building structure

Table 23 on page 71 provides the rack requirements and specifications for the switch.

Table 23: Rack Requirements and Specifications for the Switch


Rack Requirement

Guidelines

Rack type

Use a two-post rack or a four-post rack. You can mount the switch on any two-post or four-post
rack that provides bracket holes or hole patterns spaced at 1 U (1.75 in./4.45 cm) increments and
that meets the size and strength requirements to support the weight.
A U is the standard rack unit defined in Cabinets, Racks, Panels, and Associated Equipment (document
number EIA-310D) published by the Electronics Industry Association (http://www.eia.org) .
The rack must meet the strength requirements to support the weight of the chassis.

Mounting bracket hole


spacing

The holes in the mounting brackets are spaced at 1 U (1.75 in. or 4.45 cm), so that the switch can
be mounted in any rack that provides holes spaced at that distance.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

71

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 23: Rack Requirements and Specifications for the Switch (continued)
Rack Requirement

Guidelines

Rack size and strength

Ensure that the rack complies with the standard defined for 19-in. rack as defined in Cabinets,
Racks, Panels, and Associated Equipment (document number EIA-310D) published by the
Electronics Industry Association (http://www.eia.org) .

Ensure that the rack rails are spaced widely enough to accommodate the switch chassis' external
dimensions . The outer edges of the front-mounting brackets extend the width of the chassis to
19 in. (48.2 cm).

The rack must be strong enough to support the weight of the switch.

Ensure that the spacing of rails and adjacent racks allows for the proper clearance around the
switch and rack.

Secure the rack to the building structure.

If earthquakes are a possibility in your geographical area, secure the rack to the floor.

Secure the rack to the ceiling brackets as well as wall or floor brackets for maximum stability.

Rack connection to
building structure

One pair of mounting brackets for mounting the switch on two posts of a rack is supplied
with each switch. For mounting the switch on four posts of a rack or cabinet, you can
order a four-post rack-mount kit separately.

NOTE: Mounting brackets are not supplied with EX2200-C switch; they are
separately orderable.

Related
Documentation

Chassis Physical Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 9

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200 Switches
on page 74

Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings on page 184

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 95

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 98

Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet on page 102

Cabinet Requirements for EX2200 Switches


You can mount the switch in a cabinet that contains a 19-in. rack.
Cabinet requirements consist of:

Cabinet size

Clearance requirements

Cabinet airflow requirements

Table 24 on page 73 provides the cabinet requirements and specifications for the switch.

72

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 5: Mounting and Clearance Requirements

Table 24: Cabinet Requirements and Specifications for the Switch


Cabinet
Requirement

Guidelines

Cabinet size

You can mount the switch in a cabinet that contains a 19-in. rack as defined in Cabinets, Racks,
Panels, and Associated Equipment (document number EIA-310D) published by the Electronics
Industry Association (http://www.eia.org) .

The minimum cabinet size must be able to accommodate the maximum external dimensions of the
switch.

The outer edges of the mounting brackets extend the width of the chassis to 19 in. (48.2 cm).

The minimum total clearance inside the cabinet is 30 in. (76.2 cm) between the inside of the front
door and the inside of the rear door.

Cabinet clearance

Cabinet airflow
requirements

When you mount the switch in a cabinet, ensure that ventilation through the cabinet is sufficient to
prevent overheating.

Ensure adequate cool air supply to dissipate the thermal output of the switch or switches.

Ensure that the cabinet allows the hot air exhaust of the chassis to exit the cabinet without
recirculating into the switch. An open cabinet (without a top or doors) that employs hot air exhaust
extraction from the top allows the best airflow through the chassis. If the cabinet contains a top or
doors, perforations in these elements assist with removing the hot air exhaust.

Install the switch in the cabinet in a way that maximizes the open space on the side of the chassis
that has the hot air exhaust.

Route and dress all cables to minimize the blockage of airflow to and from the chassis.

Ensure that the spacing of rails and adjacent cabinets allows for the proper clearance around the
switch and cabinet.

A cabinet larger than the minimum required provides better airflow and reduces the chance of
overheating.

Related
Documentation

Chassis Physical Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 9

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200 Switches
on page 74

Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings on page 184

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 95

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 98

Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet on page 102

Requirements for Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desktop or Wall


You can install the switch on a desktop or wall. When choosing a location, allow at least
6 in. (15.2 cm) of clearance between the front and back of the chassis and adjacent
equipment or walls.
Ensure that the wall onto which the switch is installed is stable and securely supported.
If you are mounting the switch in sheetrock (wall board with a gypsum plaster core) or
in wall board not backed by wall studs, use hollow wall anchors capable of supporting

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

73

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

the combined weight of two fully loaded chassis. Insert the screws into wall studs
wherever possible to provide added support for the chassis.
Use the wall-mount kit from Juniper Networks to mount the switch on a wall. The
wall-mount kit is not part of the standard package and must be ordered separately.
Related
Documentation

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200 Switches
on page 74

Wall-Mounting Warnings for EX2200 Switches on page 189

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desk or Other Level Surface on page 89

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Wall on page 102

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200 Switches
When planning the site for installing an EX2200 switch, you must allow sufficient
clearance around the installed switch. Figure 16 on page 74 shows the clearance
requirement for EX2200 switches except the EX2200-C switch models.
Figure 17 on page 75 shows the clearance requirement for the EX2200-C switch models.

Figure 16: Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance


for EX2200 Switches Except EX2200-C Switch Models
24" (61 cm)
Clearance required
for maintenance

24" (61 cm)


6" (15.2 cm)
for airflow

Front

Rear

Mounting bracket

10.5"
(26.7 cm)

6" (15.2 cm)


for airflow

19"
(48.2 cm)

g027009

17.5"
44.5 cm

74

Clearance required
for maintenance

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 5: Mounting and Clearance Requirements

Figure 17: Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance


for EX2200-C Switch Models
24" (61 cm)
Clearance required
for maintenance

6" (15.2 cm)


for airflow

6" (15.2 cm)


Clearance
required for
maintenance

Front

Rear

Mounting bracket

19"
(48.2 cm)

g021163

7.18"
(26.9 cm)

8.7"
(22.1 cm)

6" (15.2 cm)


for airflow

The power cord retainer clips extend out of the rear of the chassis by 3 in.

Allow at least 6 in. (15.2 cm) of clearance on the side between devices that have fans
or blowers installed. Allow 2.8 in. (7 cm) between the side of the chassis and any
non-heat-producing surface such as a wall. For the cooling system to function properly,
the airflow around the chassis must be unrestricted.
Figure 18 on page 75 shows the airflow in PoE models of EX2200 switches, except for
EX2200-C models. Figure 19 on page 76 shows the airflow non-PoE models of EX2200
switches, except for EX2200-C models.

Figure 18: Airflow Through PoE Models of EX2200 Switches Except


EX2200-C Switch Models

Fans

Fan

g027008

Chassis front

Chassis rear

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

75

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Figure 19: Airflow Through Non-PoE Models of EX2200 Switches Except


EX2200-C Switch Models

g027021

Chassis front

Fans

Chassis rear

Related
Documentation

76

If you are mounting an EX2200 switch in a rack or cabinet with other equipment, or if
you are placing it on the desktop or floor near other equipment, ensure that the exhaust
from other equipment does not blow into the intake vents of the chassis.

Leave at least 24 in. (61 cm) in front of the switch and 6 in. (15.2 cm) behind the switch.
For service personnel to remove and install hardware components, you must leave
adequate space at the front and back of the switch. NEBS GR-63 recommends that
you allow at least 30 in. (76.2 cm) in front of the rack or cabinet and 24 in. (61 cm)
behind the rack or cabinet.

Rack Requirements for EX2200 Switches on page 71

Cabinet Requirements for EX2200 Switches on page 72

General Site Guidelines on page 62

Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings on page 184

Cooling System and Airflow in an EX2200 Switch on page 19

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 6

Cable Specifications

Network Cable Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 77

Network Cable Specifications for EX2200 Switches


EX2200 switches have interfaces that use various types of network cables.
For instructions on connecting the switch to a network for out-of-band management
using an Ethernet cable with an RJ-45 connector, see Connecting an EX Series Switch
to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 127.
For instructions on connecting the switch to a management console using an Ethernet
cable with an RJ-45 connector, see Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management
Console on page 129.
For instructions on connecting a fiber-optic cable to the switch, see Connecting a
Fiber-Optic Cable to an EX Series Switch on page 133.
Related
Documentation

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX2200 Switch on page 25

Console Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX Series Switch on page 23

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

77

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

78

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 7

Planning Power Requirements

Power Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 79

AC Power Cord Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 80

Power Specifications for EX2200 Switches


This topic describes the power supply electrical specifications for EX2200 switches.
Table 25 on page 79 provides the AC power supply electrical specifications for EX2200
switches.
Table 26 on page 79 provides the DC power supply electrical specifications for EX2200
switches.

Table 25: AC Power Supply Electrical Specifications for EX2200 Switches


Item

Specification

AC input voltage

100 through 240 VAC

AC input line frequency

50 Hz/60 Hz nominal

AC system current rating

7 A at 100 VAC and 2.9 A at 230 VAC (for switches with ports equipped for
PoE)

1.8 A at 100 VAC and 0.5 A at 230 VAC (for switches with no ports equipped
for PoE)

Table 26: DC Power Supply Electrical Specifications for EX2200 Switches


Item

Specification

DC input voltage

36 through 75 VDC

DC input current

3.5 A maximum

Power supply output

100 W

Output holdup time

1 ms minimum

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

79

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

NOTE: EX2200 switches with DC power supply do not provide PoE.

NOTE: For DC power supplies, we recommend that you provide at least 3.5 A
at 48 VDC and use a facility circuit breaker rated for 10 A minimum. Doing so
enables you to operate the switch in any configuration without upgrading
the power infrastructure, and allows the switch to function at full capacity
using multiple power supplies.

Related
Documentation

AC Power Cord Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 80

Power Supply in EX2200 Switches on page 18

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

AC Power Cord Specifications for EX2200 Switches


A detachable AC power cord is supplied with the AC power supplies. The coupler is type
C13 as described by International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) standard 60320.
The plug at the male end of the power cord fits into the power source outlet that is
standard for your geographical location.

CAUTION: The AC power cord provided with each power supply is intended
for use with that power supply only and not for any other use.

NOTE: In North America, AC power cords must not exceed 4.5 meters
(approximately 14.75 feet) in length, to comply with National Electrical Code
(NEC) Sections 400-8 (NFPA 75, 5-2.2) and 210-52 and Canadian Electrical
Code (CEC) Section 4-010(3). The cords supplied with the switch are in
compliance.

Table 27 on page 80 lists AC power cord specifications for the countries and regions listed
in the table.

Table 27: AC Power Cord Specifications


Country/Region

Electrical Specifications

Plug Standards

Juniper Model Number

Argentina

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

IRAM 2073 Type RA/3

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-AR

Australia

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

AS/NZZS 3112 Type SAA/3

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-AU

Brazil

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

NBR 14136 Type BR/3

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-BR

80

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 7: Planning Power Requirements

Table 27: AC Power Cord Specifications (continued)


Country/Region

Electrical Specifications

Plug Standards

Juniper Model Number

China

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

GB 1002-1996 Type PRC/3

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-CH

Europe (except Italy,


Switzerland, and United
Kingdom)

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

CEE (7) VII Type VIIG

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-EU

India

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

IS 1293 Type IND/3

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-IN

Israel

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

SI 32/1971 Type IL/3G

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-IL

Italy

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

CEI 23-16 Type I/3G

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-IT

Japan

125 VAC, 12 A, 50 Hz or 60 Hz

SS-00259 Type VCTF

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-JP

Korea

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz or 60 Hz

CEE (7) VII Type VIIGK

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-KR

North America

125 VAC, 13 A, 60 Hz

NEMA 5-15 Type N5-15

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-US

South Africa

250 VAC, 10A, 50 Hz

SABS 164/1:1992 Type ZA/13

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-SA

Switzerland

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

SEV 6534-2 Type 12G

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-SZ

Taiwan

125 VAC, 11 A and 15 A, 50 Hz

NEMA 5-15P Type N5-15P

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-TW

United Kingdom

250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz

BS 1363/A Type BS89/13

CBL-EX-PWR-C13-UK

Figure 20 on page 81 illustrates the plug on the power cord for some of the countries or
regions listed in Table 27 on page 80.

Figure 20: AC Plug Types

Related
Documentation

Power Supply in EX2200 Switches on page 18

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

Prevention of Electrostatic Discharge Damage on page 198

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

81

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

82

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

PART 3

Installing and Connecting the Switch and


Switch Components

Installing the Switch on page 85

Installing Switch Components on page 113

Connecting the Switch on page 117

Performing Initial Configuration on page 135

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

83

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

84

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 8

Installing the Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX2200 Switch on page 85

Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on page 86

Parts Inventory (Packing List) for an EX2200 Switch on page 87

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on page 88

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desk or Other Level Surface on page 89

Mounting an EX2200 Switch On or Under a Desk Using Screws on page 92

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 95

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 98

Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet on page 102

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Wall on page 102

Mounting an EX2200 Switch Using the Magnet Mount on page 109

Installing and Connecting an EX2200 Switch


To install and connect an EX2200 switch:
1.

Follow instructions in Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on page 86.

2. Mount the switch by following instructions appropriate for your site:

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 95 (using


the mounting brackets provided)

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 98 (using


the separately orderable four-post rack-mount kit)

Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet on page 102


(using the 2-in.-recess front brackets from the separately orderable four-post
rack-mount kit)

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desk or Other Level Surface on page 89 (using


the rubber feet provided)

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Wall on page 102 (using the screws or separately
orderable wall-mount kit)

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

85

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Mounting an EX2200 Switch On or Under a Desk Using Screws on page 92 (using


the desk/wall mounting screws)

Mounting an EX2200 Switch Using the Magnet Mount on page 109 (using the
separately orderable magnet sheet)

3. Follow instructions in Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch on page 117.


4. Follow instructions in Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123 or

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125.


5. Perform initial configuration of the switch by following instructions in Connecting

and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139 or Connecting and
Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142.
6. Set the switchs management options by following the appropriate instructions:

Related
Documentation

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on


page 127

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console on page 129

Rack Requirements for EX2200 Switches on page 71

Cabinet Requirements for EX2200 Switches on page 72

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200 Switches
on page 74

Unpacking an EX2200 Switch


The EX2200 switches are shipped in a cardboard carton, secured with foam packing
material. The carton also contains an accessory box.

CAUTION: EX2200 switches are maximally protected inside the shipping


carton. Do not unpack the switches until you are ready to begin installation.

To unpack the switch:


1.

Move the shipping carton to a staging area as close to the installation site as possible,
but where you have enough room to remove the system components.

2. Position the carton so that the arrows are pointing up.


3. Open the top flaps on the shipping carton.
4. Remove the accessory box and verify the contents in it against the parts inventory on

the label attached to the carton.


5. Pull out the packing material holding the switch in place.

86

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

6. Verify the chassis components received against the packing list included with the

switch. An inventory of parts provided with the switch is provided in Parts Inventory
(Packing List) for an EX2200 Switch on page 87.
7. Save the shipping carton and packing materials in case you need to move or ship the

switch later.
Related
Documentation

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on page 88

Installing and Connecting an EX2200 Switch on page 85

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Parts Inventory (Packing List) for an EX2200 Switch


The EX2200 switches are shipped in a cardboard carton, secured with foam packing
material. The carton also contains an accessory box.
The switch shipment includes a packing list. Check the parts you receive in the switch
shipping carton against the items on the packing list. The parts shipped depend on the
configuration you order.
If any part on the packing list is missing, contact your customer service representative or
contact Juniper customer care from within the U.S. or Canada by telephone at
18006388296. For international-dial or direct-dial options in countries without
toll-free numbers, see http://www.juniper.net/support/requesting-support.html .
Table 28 on page 87 lists the parts and their quantities in the packing list.

Table 28: Parts List for EX2200 Switches


Component

Quantity

Switch with built-in power supply

AC power cord appropriate for your geographical location (only for AC switch models)

Power cord retainer clip (only for AC switch models)

Mounting brackets:

EX2200 switchprovided

EX2200-C switchseparately orderable

Mounting screws to attach the mounting brackets to the switch chassis:

EX2200 switchprovided

EX2200-C switchseparately orderable

Rubber feet

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

87

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 28: Parts List for EX2200 Switches (continued)


Component

Quantity

RJ-45 cable and RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port adapter

Cable guard and 3 number-8 Phillips truss-head screws (EX2200-C models only and separately orderable)

Quick Start installation instructions

Juniper Networks Product Warranty

End User License Agreement

NOTE: You must provide mounting screws that are appropriate for your rack
or cabinet to mount the chassis on a rack or a cabinet.

Related
Documentation

Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on page 86

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Mounting an EX2200 Switch


Table 29 on page 88 lists the methods you can use to mount an EX2200 switch.

Table 29: EX2200 Switch Mounting Methods


Mounting Method

Switch Model

Comments

Desk or other level surface


(using rubber feet)

EX2200

EX2200-C

On a desk or other level surface by using rubber feet provided with


the switch

Desk or other level surface


(using screws)

EX2200-C

On or under a desk or other level surface by using screws

Two-post rack or cabinet

EX2200

EX2200-C

On two posts in a 19-in. rack or cabinet by using the mounting


brackets.

EX2200

EX2200-C

On four posts in a 19-in. rack or cabinet by using the separately


orderable four-post rack-mount kit

On two posts in a 19-in. rack or cabinet by using the two post


rack mounting brackets.

Four-post rack or cabinet

Recessed position

88

EX2200

In a position recessed 2 in. from the front of a 19-in. rack or cabinet


by using the 2-in.-recess front brackets in the separately orderable
four-post rack-mount kit. You can mount the switch in this recessed
position on two-post or four-post racks and cabinets

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

Table 29: EX2200 Switch Mounting Methods (continued)


Mounting Method

Switch Model

Comments

Wall mount

EX2200

EX2200-C

On a wall by using screws or separately orderable wall-mount


kit

On a wall by using screws

Magnet mount

EX2200-C

On or under a surface made of ferrous material using the separately


orderable magnet sheet

WARNING:

When mounting an EX2200 switch chassis in a vertical position, orient the


front panel of the chassis downward to ensure proper airflow and meet
safety requirements in the event of a fire.

When wall mounting EX2200-24P and EX2200-48P models, install the


wall-mount baffle above the units to reduce the risk of objects or
substances falling into the air exhaust or power supply, which could cause
a fire.

The holes in the mounting brackets are placed at 1 U (1.75 in. or 4.45 cm) apart so that
the switch can be mounted in any rack or cabinet that provides holes spaced at that
distance.
See the Related Documentation for detailed descriptions of the various rack or cabinet
mounting options.
Related
Documentation

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 95

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 98

Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet on page 102

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desk or Other Level Surface on page 89

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Wall on page 102

Mounting an EX2200 Switch On or Under a Desk Using Screws on page 92

Mounting an EX2200 Switch Using the Magnet Mount on page 109

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch on page 117

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Desk or Other Level Surface


You can mount an EX2200 switch on a desk or other level surface by using the four rubber
feet that are shipped with the switch. The rubber feet stabilize the chassis.
Before mounting the switch on a desk or other level surface:

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

89

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Verify that the site meets the requirements described in Site Preparation Checklist
for EX2200 Switches on page 61.

Place the desk in its permanent location, allowing adequate clearance for airflow and
maintenance, and secure it to the building structure.

Read General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169, with particular attention
to Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches on page 183.

NOTE: Do not block the vents on the top of the EX2200-C switches. Doing
this can lead to overheating of the switch chassis.

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

4 rubber feet to stabilize the chassis on the a desk or other level surface (provided in
the accessory box in the switch carton)

1 cable guard and 3 number-8 Phillips truss-head screws (optional and separately
orderable) to secure the cable guard to the EX2200-C switch

1 standard cable lock (optional and separately orderable) to secure the EX2200-C
switch models only from theft by connecting the cable to the security slots on the
switch

To mount a switch on a desk or other level surface:


1.

Remove the switch from the shipping carton (see Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on
page 86).

2. Turn the chassis upside down on the desk or the level surface where you intend to

mount the switch.


3. Attach the rubber feet to the bottom of the chassis, as shown in Figure 21 on page 90.
4. Turn the chassis right side up on the desk or the level surface.

SPD
DX
EN
POE

g027015

S
SY

AL

Figure 21: Attaching Rubber Feet to a Switch Chassis

Rubber feet

5. (Optional; applies only to EX2200-C models) Attach the cable guard to protect cable

connections:
a. Use the 3 truss-head screws to attach the cable guard to the bottom of the chassis.

90

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

b. Use the thumbscrews to tighten or loosen the guard to allow you to insert cables.

See Figure 22 on page 91.

g021161

Figure 22: Attaching a Cable Guard to an EX2200-C Switch

6. (Optional; applies only to EX2200-C models) Attach the standard cable lock to the

security slots on the both sides of the switch:


a. Rope the cable to a desk or a rack and set the lock to unlocked position.
b. Insert the lock into one of the security slot on your chassis and set the lock to the

locked position. See Figure 23 on page 91.

Figure 23: Securing the EX2200-C Switch Using Security Slots

Security slot

g021160

Security cable

Related
Documentation

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for EX2200 Switches
on page 74

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

91

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Mounting an EX2200 Switch On or Under a Desk Using Screws


This topic applies only to the EX2200-C switch, the compact, fanless model.
You can mount an EX2200-C switch on or under a desk or other level surface by using
the flexible mounting slots on the bottom of the chassis to secure the switch.
Before mounting the switch on or under a desk or other lever surface:

Verify that the site meets the requirements described in Site Preparation Checklist
for EX2200 Switches on page 61.

Place the desk in its permanent location, allowing adequate clearance for airflow and
maintenance, and secure it to the building structure.

Read General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169, with particular attention
to Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches on page 183.

Remove the switch from the shipping carton (see Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on
page 86).

NOTE: Do not block the vents on the top of the EX2200-C switches. Doing
this can lead to overheating of the switch chassis.

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

3 desk mounting screws (M4 x 30mm or 8-32 x 1.25 in. Phillips pan-head machine
screwsnot provided)

Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 2.

1 cable guard and 3 number-8 Phillips truss-head screws (optional and separately
orderable) to secure the cable guard to the switch

1 standard cable lock (optional and separately orderable) to secure the switch from
theft by connecting the cable to the security slots on the switch

To mount the switch on or under a desk or other level surface:


1.

92

Drill three holes A, B, and C on or under the desk as shown in Figure 24 on page 93.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

Figure 24: Measurements for Installing Mounting Screws for EX2200-C


Switch
9.52"
(22.1 cm)

.536"
(1.36 cm)

3.98"
(10.13 cm)

3.98"
(10.13 cm)

4.37"
(11.0 cm)

g021164

a. Drill hole A and install a mounting screw.


b. Drill hole B 9.52 in. (22.1 cm) on a level line from hole A and install a mounting

screw.
c. Mark a point P 3.98 in. (10.13 cm) on a plumb line down from hole A.
d. From point P 4.37 in. (11.0 cm) on a level line drill hole C and install a mounting

screw.
2. Tighten the screws only part way in, leaving about 1/4 in. (6 mm) distance between

the head of the screw and the desk.


3. Place the switch on the mounting screws, and slide it forward or backward until it

locks in place. See Figure 25 on page 94.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

93

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

g021157

Figure 25: Mounting the EX2200-C Switch On or Under a Desk Using


Screws

4. (Optional) Attach the cable guard to protect cable connections:


a. Use the 3 truss-head screws to attach the cable guard to the bottom of the chassis.
b. Use the thumbscrews to tighten or loosen the guard to allow you to insert cables.

See Figure 26 on page 95.

94

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

g021161

Figure 26: Attaching a Cable Guard to an EX2200-C Switch

5. (Optional) Attach the standard cable lock to the security slots on the both sides of

the switch
a. Rope the cable to a desk or a rack and set the lock to unlocked position.
b. Insert the lock into one of the security slot on your chassis and set the lock to the

locked position. See Figure 27 on page 95.

Figure 27: Securing the EX2200-C Switch Using Security Slots

Security slot

g021160

Security cable

Related
Documentation

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Wall-Mounting Warnings for EX2200 Switches on page 189

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet


You can mount all EX2200 switches on two posts of a two-post or a four-post 19-in. rack
or cabinet using the mounting brackets and screws provided with all EX2200 switches
except the EX2200-C switches. For EX2200-C switches, mounting brackets and screws

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

95

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

are separately orderable. (The remainder of this topic uses rack to mean rack or
cabinet.)

NOTE: If you need to mount an EX2200 switch except the EX2200-C switch
models in a recessed position on either a two-post rack or a four-post rack,
you can use the 2-in.-recess front mount brackets provided in the separately
orderable four-post rack-mount kit. EX2200-C cannot be mounted in a
recessed position.

NOTE: Do not block the vents on the top of the EX2200-C switches. Doing
this can lead to overheating of the switch chassis.

Before mounting the switch on two posts of a two-post or a four-post rack:

Verify that the site meets the requirements described in Site Preparation Checklist
for EX2200 Switches on page 61.

Place the rack in its permanent location, allowing adequate clearance for airflow and
maintenance, and secure it to the building structure.

Read General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169, with particular attention
to Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches on page 183.

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 2

2 mounting brackets and 8 mounting screws (provided with EX2200 switches except
the EX2200-C switch model )

Screws to secure the chassis to the rack (not provided)

2-in.-recess front brackets from the separately orderable four-post rack-mount kit if
you will mount the switch in a recessed position (not applicable for EX2200-C switches).

NOTE: One person must be available to lift the switch while another secures
the switch to the rack.

CAUTION: If you are mounting multiple units on a rack, mount the heaviest
unit at the bottom of the rack and mount the other units from the bottom of
the rack to the top in decreasing order of the weight of the units.

96

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

To mount the switch on two posts of a two-post or a four-post rack:


1.

Remove the switch from the shipping carton (see Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on
page 86).

2. Place the switch on a flat, stable surface.


3. Align the mounting brackets along the front or rear of the side panels of the switch

chassis depending on how you want to mount the switch. For example, if you want
to front-mount the switch, align the brackets along the front of the chassis.
Figure 28 on page 97 shows attaching the mounting brackets along the front of the
EX2200 switch.

S
SY

ALM

Figure 28: Attaching the Mounting Bracket Along the Front of the Switch

SPD
DX
EN

g027019

POE

NOTE: The length of the mounting brackets depends on the switch model.

4. Align the bottom holes in the mounting brackets with holes on the side panels of the

switch chassis.
5. Insert the mounting screws into the aligned holes. Tighten the screws.
6. Ensure that the other holes in the mounting brackets are aligned with the holes in the

side panels. Insert a screw in each hole and tighten the screws.
7. Have one person grasp both sides of the switch, lift the switch, and position it in the

rack, aligning the mounting bracket holes with the threaded holes in the rack or cabinet
rail. Align the bottom hole in each mounting bracket with a hole in each rack rail,
making sure the chassis is level. See Figure 29 on page 98.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

97

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Figure 29: Mounting the Switch on Two Posts of a Rack


Mounting rack

g027020

Mounting bracket

8. Have a second person secure the switch to the rack by using the appropriate screws.

Tighten the screws.


9. Ensure that the switch chassis is level by verifying that all screws on one side of the

rack are aligned with the screws on the other side.


Related
Documentation

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 98

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch on page 117

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet on page 102

Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings on page 184

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet


You can mount an EX2200 switch except an EX2200-C switch model on four posts of
a 19-in. rack or cabinet by using the separately orderable four-post rack-mount kit. (The
remainder of this topic uses rack to mean rack or cabinet.)

NOTE: EX2200-C switches cannot be mounted on all four posts of a rack.

98

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

NOTE: If you need to mount an EX2200 switch except the EX2200-C switch
model in a recessed position on either a two-post rack or a four-post rack,
you can use the 2-in.-recess front-mounting brackets provided in the
separately orderable four-post rack-mount kit. EX2200-C switches cannot
be mounted in a recessed position.

Before mounting the switch on four posts of a rack:

Verify that the site meets the requirements described in Site Preparation Checklist
for EX2200 Switches on page 61.

Place the rack in its permanent location, allowing adequate clearance for airflow and
maintenance, and secure it to the building structure.

Read General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169, with particular attention
to Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches on page 183.

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 2

6 Phillips 4-40 flat-head mounting screws (provided with the four-post rack-mount
kit)

8 Phillips 4x6-mm flat-head mounting screws (provided with the four-post rack-mount
kit)

One pair each of flush or 2-in.-recess front-mounting brackets

One pair of side mounting-rails

One pair of rear mounting-blades

Screws to secure the chassis and the rear mounting-blades to the rack (not provided)

NOTE: One person must be available to lift the switch while another secures
it to the rack.

CAUTION: If you are mounting multiple units on a rack, mount the heaviest
unit at the bottom of the rack and mount the other units from the bottom of
the rack to the top in decreasing order of the weight of the units.

To mount the switch on four posts of a rack:


1.

Remove the switch from the shipping carton (see Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on
page 86).

2. Attach the front-mounting brackets (either the flush or the 2-in.-recess brackets) to

the side mounting-rails using 6 Phillips 4-40 flat-head mounting screws. See
Figure 30 on page 100.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

99

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Figure 30: Attaching the Front-Mounting Bracket to the Side Mounting-Rail

1 Side mounting-rail

2 Front-mounting bracket

3. Place the switch on a flat, stable surface.


4. Align the side mounting-rails along the side panels of the switch chassis. Align the

two holes in the rear of the side mounting-rails with the two holes on the rear of the
side panel.
5. Insert Phillips 4x6-mm flat-head mounting screws into the two aligned holes and

tighten the screws. Ensure that the two holes in the rear of the side mounting-rails
are aligned with the remaining two holes in the side panel. See Figure 31 on page 100.

g027017

Figure 31: Attaching the Side Mounting-Rail to the Switch Chassis

6. Insert the Phillips 4x6-mm flat-head mounting screws into the remaining two holes

in the side mounting-rails and tighten the screws.


7. Have one person grasp both sides of the switch, lift the switch, and position it in the

rack, aligning the side mounting-rail holes with the threaded holes in the front post
of the rack. Align the bottom hole in both the front-mounting brackets with a hole in
each rack rail, making sure the chassis is level. See Figure 32 on page 101.

100

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

Figure 32: Mounting the Switch to the Front Posts of a Rack

1 Side mounting-rail

2 Front-mounting bracket

8. Have a second person secure the front of the switch to the rack by using the appropriate

screws for your rack.


9. Slide the rear mounting-blades into the side mounting-rails. See Figure 33 on page 101.

Figure 33: Sliding the Rear Mounting-Blades into the Side Mounting-Rail

1 Rear mounting-blades

3 Switch

2Side mounting-rail
10. Attach the rear mounting-blades to the rear post by using the appropriate screws for

your rack. Tighten the screws.


11. Ensure that the switch chassis is level by verifying that all the screws on the front of

the rack are aligned with the screws at the back of the rack.
Related
Documentation

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 95

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch on page 117

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

101

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet on page 102

Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings on page 184

Mounting an EX2200 Switch in a Recessed Position in a Rack or Cabinet


You can mount an EX2200 switch except the EX2200-C switch model in a rack or cabinet
such that the switch is recessed inside the rack from the rack front by 2 inches. You can
use the 2-in.-recess front brackets provided in the separately orderable four-post
rack-mount kit to mount the switch in a recessed position.
Reasons that you might want to mount the switch in a recessed position include:

You are mounting the switch in a cabinet and the cabinet doors will not close completely
unless the switch is recessed.

The switch you are mounting has transceivers installed in the uplink portsthe
transceivers in the uplink ports protrude from the front of the switch.

To mount the switch in a recessed position on four posts, follow the instructions in
Mounting an EX2200 Switch on Four Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 98. To mount
the switch in a recessed position on two posts, follow the instructions in Mounting an
EX2200 Switch on Two Posts of a Rack or Cabinet on page 95.
Related
Documentation

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch on page 117

Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings on page 184

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Wall


This topic describes the process of mounting an EX2200 switch on a wall.
1.

Mounting an EX2200 Switch Except the EX2200-C Model on a Wall on page 102

2. Mounting an EX2200-C Switch on a Wall on page 105

Mounting an EX2200 Switch Except the EX2200-C Model on a Wall


You can mount an EX2200 switch on a wall by using the separately orderable wall-mount
kit.

WARNING:

102

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

When mounting an EX2200 switch chassis in a vertical position, orient the


front panel of the chassis downward to ensure proper airflow and meet
safety requirements in the event of a fire.

When wall mounting Power over Ethernet (PoE) models (EX2200-24P


and EX2200-48P), install the wall-mount baffle above the units to reduce
the risk of objects or substances falling into the air exhaust or power supply,
which could cause a fire.

Before mounting the switch on a wall:

Verify that the site meets the requirements described in Site Preparation Checklist
for EX2200 Switches on page 61.

Read General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169, with particular attention
to Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches on page 183.

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

2 wall-mount brackets (provided in the wall-mount kit)

1 wall-mount baffle (provided in the wall-mount kit)

12 wall-mount bracket screws (provided in the wall-mount kit)

6 mounting screws (8-32 x 1.25 in. or M4 x 30 mm) (not provided)

Hollow wall anchors rated to support up to 75 lb (34 kg) if you are not screwing the
screws directly into wall studs (not provided)

Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 2

To mount one or two switches on a wall:


1.

Remove the switch from the shipping carton (see Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on
page 86).

2. Attach the wall-mount brackets to the sides of the chassis using four wall-mount

bracket screws on each side, as shown in Figure 34 on page 104.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

103

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Figure 34: Attaching Wall-Mount Brackets to a Switch Chassis


Baffle for PoE Models
(EX2200-24P and EX2200-48P)

g027022

Rear panel

Front panel

3. If you are mounting two switches together, align the second switch on top of the first

and attach it to the mounting brackets using two additional wall-mount bracket
screws on each side. (Figure 36 on page 105 shows two aligned switches.)
4. Install four mounting screws in the wall for the wall-mount brackets (and two more

for the baffle if you are installing a switch that supports PoE) as shown in
Figure 35 on page 105:

Use hollow wall anchors rated to support up to 75 lb (34 kg) if you are not inserting
the mounting screws directly into wall studs.

Turn the screws only part way in, leaving about 1/4 in. (6 mm) distance between
the head of the screw and the wall.

a. Install screw A.
b. Install screw B 18.68 in. (47.4 cm) from screw A on a level line.
c. Install screw C 5.98 in. (15.2 cm) on a plumb line down from screw A and screw D

5.98 in. down from screw B.


d. For PoE models, install screw E 2.76 in. (7 cm) up from and 8.32 in. (21.1 cm) to the

right of screw A.
e. For PoE models, install screw F 4.49 in. (11.4 cm) to the right of screw E.

104

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

Figure 35: Measurements for Installing Mounting Screws


Rear

Baffle for PoE Models


(EX2200-24P and EX2200-48P)

18.68 in. (47.4 cm)


4.49 in.
(11.4 cm)

8.32 in. (21.1 cm)


E

2.76 in (7 cm)

D
g021067

5.98 in.
(15.2 cm)

Side wall-mount brackets


Front

5. Lift the unit (one switch or two) by grasping each side, and hang the unit by attaching

the brackets to the mounting screws as shown in Figure 36 on page 105.


6. For PoE models, install the baffle by attaching it to screws E and F.
7. Tighten all mounting screws.

Figure 36: Mounting the Switch on a Wall


Baffle for PoE Models
Rear
panel

(EX2200-24P and EX2200-48P)

Front
panel

g020723

Hang attached brackets


on wall-mounted screws.

Mounting an EX2200-C Switch on a Wall


You can mount an EX2200-C switch, the compact, fanless model, on a wall by using the
flexible mounting slots on the bottom of the chassis to fix to the screws on the wall.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

105

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

WARNING: When mounting an EX2200-C switch chassis in a vertical position,


orient the front panel of the chassis downward to ensure proper airflow and
meet safety requirements in the event of a fire.

NOTE: Do not block the vents on the top of the EX2200-C switches. Doing
this can lead to overheating of the switch chassis.

Before mounting the switch on a wall:

Verify that the site meets the requirements described in Site Preparation Checklist
for EX2200 Switches on page 61.

Read General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169, with particular attention
to Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches on page 183.

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

3 wall mounting screws (M4 x 30mm or 8-32 x 1.25 in. Phillips pan-head machine
screwsnot provided)

Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 2

1 cable guard and 3 number-8 Phillips truss-head screws (optional and separately
orderable) to secure the cable guard to the switch

1 standard cable lock (optional and separately orderable) to secure the switch from
theft by connecting the cable to a security slot on the switch

To mount the switch on a wall:


1.

Remove the switch from the shipping carton (see Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on
page 86).

2. Drill three holes A, B, and C on the wall as shown in Figure 37 on page 107.

106

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

Figure 37: Measurements for Installing Mounting Screws for the EX2200-C
Switch
9.52"
(22.1 cm)

.536"
(1.36 cm)

3.98"
(10.13 cm)

3.98"
(10.13 cm)

4.37"
(11.0 cm)

g021164

a. Drill hole A and install a mounting screw.


b. Drill hole B 9.52 in. (22.1 cm) on a level line from hole A and install a mounting

screw.
c. Mark a point P 3.98 in. (10.13 cm) on a plumb line down from hole A.
d. From point P 4.37 in. (11.0 cm) on a level line drill hole C and install a mounting

screw.
3. Tighten the screws only part way in, leaving about 1/4 in. (6 mm) distance between

the head of the screw and the wall.


4. Mount the switch on the mounting screws facing front panel downwards, and slide it

downward until it locks in place as shown in Figure 38 on page 108.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

107

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

g021159

Figure 38: Mounting the EX2200-C Switch on a Wall Using Screws

5. (Optional) Attach the optional cable guard to protect cable connections:


a. Use the 3 truss-head screws to attach the cable guard to the bottom of the chassis.
b. Use the thumbscrews to tighten or loosen the guard to allow you to insert cables.

See Figure 39 on page 108.

g021161

Figure 39: Attaching a Cable Guard to an EX2200-C Switch

6. (Optional) Attach the optional standard cable lock to a security slot on the side of

the switch:
a. Rope the cable to a desk or a rack and set the lock to the unlocked position.
b. Insert the lock into a security slot on your chassis and set the lock to the locked

position. See Figure 40 on page 109.

108

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

Figure 40: Securing the EX2200-C Switch Using Security Slots

Security slot

g021160

Security cable

Related
Documentation

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Wall-Mounting Warnings for EX2200 Switches on page 189

Mounting an EX2200 Switch Using the Magnet Mount


This topic applies only to the EX2200-C switch, the compact, fanless model.
You can mount an EX2200-C switch on or under a surface made of ferrous material using
the separately orderable magnet sheet.

WARNING: When mounting an EX2200-C switch chassis in a vertical position,


orient the front panel of the chassis downward to ensure proper airflow and
meet safety requirements in the event of a fire.

NOTE: Do not block the vents on the top of the EX2200-C switches. Doing
this can lead to overheating of the switch chassis.

Before mounting the switch using magnet mount:

Ensure that no rubber feet are installed on the bottom of the switch.

Verify that the site meets the requirements described in Site Preparation Checklist
for EX2200 Switches on page 61.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

109

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Place the desk in its permanent location, allowing adequate clearance for airflow and
maintenance, and secure it to the building structure.

Read General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169, with particular attention
to Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches on page 183.

Remove the switch from the shipping carton (see Unpacking an EX2200 Switch on
page 86).

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

Magnet sheet (separately orderable)

Flat surface made of ferrous material

1 cable guard and 3 number-8 Phillips truss-head screws (optional and separately
orderable) to secure the cable guard to the switch

1 standard cable lock (optional and separately orderable) to secure the switch from
theft by connecting the cable to the security slots on the switch

1.

Mount the switch under a ferrous surface using magnet mount:


a. Turn the chassis upside down.
b. Place the magnet sheet on the bottom of the chassis.

NOTE: You can place the magnet sheet only at the bottom of the
switch.

c. Mount the magnet sheet along with the switch under the surface where you want

to mount the switch.


2. Mount the switch vertically on a ferrous surface using magnet mount:
a. Place the magnet sheet at the bottom of the chassis.

NOTE: You can place the magnet sheet only at the bottom of the
switch.

b. Mount the magnet along with the switch on the ferrous surface where you want

to mount the switch orienting the front panel downwards as shown in


Figure 41 on page 111.

110

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 8: Installing the Switch

Figure 41: Mounting an EX2200-C Switch Using Magnet Mount


Magnetic surface

g021158

Magnet mount

3. (Optional) Attach the cable guard to protect cable connections:


a. Use the 3 truss-head screws to attach the cable guard to the bottom of the chassis.
b. Use the thumbscrews to tighten or loosen the guard to allow you to insert cables.

See Figure 42 on page 112.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

111

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

g021161

Figure 42: Attaching a Cable Guard to an EX2200-C Switch

4. (Optional) Attach the standard cable lock to the security slots on the both sides of

the switch
a. Rope the cable to a desk or a rack and set the lock to unlocked position.
b. Insert the lock into one of the security slot on your chassis and set the lock to the

locked position. See Figure 43 on page 112.

Figure 43: Securing the EX2200-C Switch Using Security Slots

Security slot

g021160

Security cable

Related
Documentation

112

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Wall-Mounting Warnings for EX2200 Switches on page 189

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 9

Installing Switch Components

Installing a Transceiver in an EX Series Switch on page 113

Installing a Transceiver in an EX Series Switch


The transceivers for EX Series switches are hot-removable and hot-insertable
field-replaceable units (FRUs): You can remove and replace them without powering off
the switch or disrupting switch functions.

NOTE: After you insert a transceiver or after you change the media-type
configuration, wait for 6 seconds for the interface to display operational
commands.

Use only optical transceivers and optical connectors purchased from Juniper Networks
for your EX Series switches.

NOTE: On an EX3200 switch, if you install a transceiver in a 1-Gigabit Ethernet


uplink module port, a corresponding network port from the last four built-in
ports is disabled. For example, if you install a transceiver in the uplink module
port 3 (ge-0/1/2), then the built-in port 23 (ge-0/0/22) is disabled. The
disabled port is not listed in the output of show interface commands.

Before you begin installing a transceiver in an EX Series switch, ensure that you have
taken the necessary precautions for safe handling of lasers (see Laser and LED Safety
Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches on page 175).
Ensure that you have a rubber safety cap available to cover the transceiver.
Figure 44 on page 115 shows how to install a QSFP+ transceiver. The procedure is the
same for all types of transceivers.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

113

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

To install a transceiver in an EX Series switch:

CAUTION: To prevent electrostatic discharge (ESD) damage to the


transceiver, do not touch the connector pins at the end of the transceiver.

1.

Remove the transceiver from its bag.

2. Check to see whether the transceiver is covered with a rubber safety cap. If it is not,

cover the transceiver with a rubber safety cap.

WARNING: Do not leave a fiber-optic transceiver uncovered except when


inserting or removing a cable. The rubber safety cap keeps the port clean
and prevents accidental exposure to laser light.

3. If the port in which you want to install the transceiver is covered with a dust cover,

remove the dust cover and save it in case you need to cover the port later. If you are
hot-swapping a transceiver, wait for at least 10 seconds after removing the transceiver
from the port before installing a new transceiver.
4. Using both hands, carefully place the transceiver in the empty port. The connectors

must face the switch chassis.

CAUTION: Before you slide the transceiver into the port, ensure that the
transceiver is aligned correctly. Misalignment might cause the pins to
bend, making the transceiver unusable.

5. Slide the transceiver in gently until it is fully seated. If you are installing a CFP

transceiver, tighten the captive screws on the transceiver by using your fingers.
6. Remove the rubber safety cap when you are ready to connect the cable to the

transceiver.

WARNING: Do not look directly into a fiber-optic transceiver or into the


ends of fiber-optic cables. Fiber-optic transceivers and fiber-optic cables
connected to transceivers emit laser light that can damage your eyes.

114

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 9: Installing Switch Components

Figure 44: Installing a Transceiver in an EX Series Switch

1 Ejector lever

Related
Documentation

Removing a Transceiver from an EX Series Switch on page 149

Connecting a Fiber-Optic Cable to an EX Series Switch on page 133

Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX Series Switches

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

115

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

116

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 10

Connecting the Switch

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch on page 117

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 127

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console on page 129

Connecting an EX2200 Switch to a Management Console Using Mini-USB Type-B


Console Port on page 131

Connecting a Fiber-Optic Cable to an EX Series Switch on page 133

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch


To ensure proper operation and to meet safety and electromagnetic interference (EMI)
requirements, you must connect an EX Series switch to earth ground before you connect
power to the switch. You must use the protective earthing terminal on the switch chassis
to connect the switch to earth ground (see Figure 46 on page 122).

WARNING: The switch is installed in a restricted-access location. It has a


separate protective earthing terminal on the chassis that must be permanently
connected to earth ground to adequately ground the chassis and protect the
operator from electrical hazards.

CAUTION: Before switch installation begins, ensure that a licensed electrician


has attached an appropriate grounding lug to the grounding cable that you
supply. Using a grounding cable with an incorrectly attached lug can damage
the switch.

This topic describes:

Parts and Tools Required for Connecting an EX Series Switch to Earth


Ground on page 118

Special Instructions to Follow Before Connecting Earth Ground to a Switch on page 120

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch on page 122

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

117

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Parts and Tools Required for Connecting an EX Series Switch to Earth Ground
Table 30 on page 118 lists the earthing terminal location, grounding cable requirements,
grounding lug specifications, screws and washers required, and the screwdriver needed
for connecting a switch to earth ground. Before you begin connecting a switch to earth
ground, ensure you have the parts and tools required for your switch.

Table 30: Parts and Tools Required for Connecting an EX Series Switch to Earth Ground

Switch
EX2200

EX3200

EX3300

EX4200

118

Earthing
Terminal
Location
Rear panel
of chassis

Rear panel
of chassis

Rear panel
of chassis

Left side of
chassis

Grounding Cable
Requirements

Grounding Lug
Specifications

Screws and
Washers

14 AWG (2 mm),
minimum 90C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

Panduit
LCC10-14BWL or
equivalent
not provided

Two 10-32
x .25 in. screws
with #10
split-lock
washer
not provided

Two #10 flat


washersnot
provided

Two 10-32
x .25 in. screws
with #10
split-lock
washer
not provided

Two #10 flat


washers
not provided

Two 10-32
x .25 in. screws
with #10
split-lock
washer
not provided

Two #10 flat


washers
not provided

Two 10-32
x .25 in. screws
with #10
split-lock
washer
not provided

Two #10 flat


washers
not provided

14 AWG (2 mm),
minimum 90C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

14 AWG (2 mm),
minimum 90C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

14 WG (2 mm),
minimum 90C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

Panduit
LCC10-14BWL or
equivalent
not provided

Panduit
LCC10-14BWL or
equivalent
not provided

Panduit
LCC10-14BWL or
equivalent
not provided

Screwdriver

Additional
Information

Phillips (+)
number 2

Phillips (+)
number 2

See Special
Instructions to
Follow Before
Connecting Earth
Ground to a Switch
on page 120.

Phillips (+)
number 2

Phillips (+)
number 2

See Special
Instructions to
Follow Before
Connecting Earth
Ground to a Switch
on page 120.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 10: Connecting the Switch

Table 30: Parts and Tools Required for Connecting an EX Series Switch to Earth
Ground (continued)

Switch
EX4300

EX4500

EX4550

EX6210

EX8208

Earthing
Terminal
Location
Left side of
chassis

Left side of
chassis

Left side of
chassis

Rear panel
of chassis
(on lower
left side)

Left side of
chassis

Grounding Cable
Requirements

Grounding Lug
Specifications

Screws and
Washers

14 AWG (2 mm),
minimum 90C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

Panduit
LCC10-14BWL or
equivalent
not provided

Two 10-32
x .25 in. screws
with #10
split-lock
washer
not provided

Two #10 flat


washers
not provided

Two 10-32
x .25 in. screws
with #10
split-lock
washer
not provided

Two #10 flat


washers
not provided

Two 10-32
x .25 in. screws
with #10
split-lock
washer
not provided

Two #10 flat


washers
not provided

Two -20
x 0.5 in. screws
with #
split-washer
provided

Two # flat
washers
provided

Two -20
x 0.5 in. screws
with #
split-washer
provided

Two # flat
washers
provided

14 AWG (2 mm),
minimum 90C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

14 AWG (2 mm),
minimum 90C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

Panduit
LCC10-14BWL or
equivalent
not provided

Panduit
LCC10-14BWL or
equivalent
not provided

The grounding cable


must be the same
gage as the power
feed cables and as
permitted by the
local code.

Panduit
LCD2-14A-Q or
equivalent
provided

6 AWG (13.3 mm),


minimum 60C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

Panduit
LCD2-14A-Q or
equivalent
provided

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Screwdriver

Additional
Information

Phillips (+)
number 2

See Special
Instructions to
Follow Before
Connecting Earth
Ground to a Switch
on page 120.

Phillips (+)
number 2

See Special
Instructions to
Follow Before
Connecting Earth
Ground to a Switch
on page 120.

Phillips (+)
number 2

See Special
Instructions to
Follow Before
Connecting Earth
Ground to a Switch
on page 120.

Phillips (+)
number 2

Phillips (+)
number 2

119

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Table 30: Parts and Tools Required for Connecting an EX Series Switch to Earth
Ground (continued)

Switch
EX8216

Earthing
Terminal
Location
Two
earthing
terminals:

EX9204

EX9208

EX9214

Grounding Cable
Requirements

Grounding Lug
Specifications

Screws and
Washers

2 AWG (33.6 mm),


minimum 60C wire,
or as permitted by
the local code

Panduit
LCD2-14A-Q or
equivalent
provided

Two -20 x
0.5 in. screws
with #
split-washer
provided

Two # flat
washers
provided

Two -20
x 0.5 in. screws
with #
split-washer
provided

Two # flat
washers
provided

Two -20
x 0.5 in. screws
with #
split-washer
provided

Two # flat
washers
provided

Two -20
x 0.5 in. screws
with #
split-washer
provided

Two # flat
washers
provided

Left side
of
chassis
Rear
panel of
chassis

Rear panel
of chassis

Rear panel
of chassis

Rear panel
of chassis

One 6 AWG (13.3


mm), minimum
60C wire, or one
that complies with
the local code

One 6 AWG (13.3


mm), minimum
60C wire, or one
that complies with
the local code

One 6 AWG (13.3


mm), minimum
60C wire, or one
that complies with
the local code

Thomas&Betts
LCN6-14 or
equivalent
provided

Thomas&Betts
LCN6-14 or
equivalent
provided

Thomas&Betts
LCN6-14 or
equivalent
provided

Screwdriver
Phillips (+)
number 2

Additional
Information
See Special
Instructions to
Follow Before
Connecting Earth
Ground to a Switch
on page 120.

Phillips (+)
number 2

Phillips (+)
number 2

Phillips (+)
number 2

Special Instructions to Follow Before Connecting Earth Ground to a Switch


Table 31 on page 120 lists the special instructions that you might need to follow before
connecting earth ground to a switch.

Table 31: Special Instructions to Follow Before Connecting Earth Ground to a Switch
Switch

Special Instructions

EX3200

NOTE: Some early variants of EX3200 switches for which the Juniper Networks model number on the label
next to the protective earthing terminal is from 750-021xxx through 750-030xxx require 10-24x.25 in. screws.

120

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 10: Connecting the Switch

Table 31: Special Instructions to Follow Before Connecting Earth Ground to a Switch (continued)
Switch

Special Instructions

EX4200

NOTE: Some early variants of EX4200 switches for which the Juniper Networks model number on the label
next to the protective earthing terminal is from 750-021xxx through 750-030xxx require 10-24x.25 in. screws.
NOTE: The protective earthing terminal on an EX4200 switch mounted on four posts of a rack is accessible
through the slot on the left rear bracket only if the rack is 27.5 in. through 30.5 in. deep for a switch mounted
flush with the rack front and 29.5 in. through 32.5 in. deep for a switch mounted 2 in. recessed from the rack
front. See Figure 45 on page 121.

g004479

Figure 45: Connecting the Grounding Lug to a Switch Mounted on Four Posts
of a Rack

1 Protective earthing terminal

3 Grounding lug

2 Side mounting-rail

4 Rear mounting-blade

NOTE: The brackets must be attached to the chassis before the grounding lug is attached. (The brackets
are shown pulled away from the chassis so that the protective earthing terminal is seen.)
EX4300

NOTE: The protective earthing terminal on an EX4300 switch mounted on four posts of a rack is accessible
through the slot on the left rear bracket only if the rack is 27.5 in. through 30.5 in. deep for a switch mounted
flush with the rack front and 29.5 in. through 32.5 in. deep for a switch mounted 2 in. recessed from the rack
front.

EX4500

NOTE: If you plan to mount your switch on four posts of a rack or cabinet, mount your switch in the rack
or cabinet before attaching the grounding lug to the switch. See Mounting an EX4500 Switch on Four Posts
in a Rack or Cabinet.
NOTE: The protective earthing terminal on an EX4500 switch mounted on four posts of a rack is accessible
through the slot on the left rear bracket only if the rack is 27.5 in. through 30.5 in. deep for a switch mounted
flush with the rack front and 29.5 in. through 32.5 in. deep for a switch mounted 2 in. recessed from the rack
front.

EX4550

NOTE: The protective earthing terminal on an EX4550 switch mounted on four posts of a rack is accessible
through the slot on the left rear bracket only if the rack is 27.5 in. through 30.5 in. deep for a switch mounted
flush with the rack front and 29.5 in. through 32.5 in. deep for a switch mounted 2 in. recessed from the rack
front.

EX8216

NOTE: Only one of the two protective earthing terminals needs to be permanently connected to earth
ground.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

121

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series Switch


To connect earth ground to a switch:
1.

Connect one end of the grounding cable to a proper earth ground, such as the rack in
which the switch is mounted.

2. Place the grounding lug attached to the grounding cable over the protective earthing

terminal. See Figure 46 on page 122.

Figure 46: Connecting a Grounding Cable to an EX Series Switch

3. Secure the grounding lug to the protective earthing terminal with the washers and

screws.
4. Dress the grounding cable and ensure that it does not touch or block access to other

switch components.

WARNING: Ensure that the cable does not drape where people could trip
over it.

Related
Documentation

122

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Connecting AC Power to an EX3200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX3200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX3300 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX3300 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4300 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4300 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4500 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4500 Switch

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 10: Connecting the Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4550 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4550 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX6200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX6200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX8200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX8200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9204 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX9204 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9208 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX9208 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9214 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX9214 Switch

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch


The power supply in an EX2200 switch is located on the rear panel.
Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

A power cord appropriate for your geographical location

A power cord retainer clip

Ensure that you have connected the switch chassis to earth ground.

CAUTION: To meet safety and electromagnetic interference (EMI)


requirements and to ensure proper operation, you must connect the switches
to earth ground before you connect them to power. For installations that
require a separate grounding conductor to the chassis, use the protective
earthing terminal on the switch chassis to connect to the earth ground. For
instructions on connecting earth ground, see Connecting Earth Ground to
an EX Series Switch on page 117. An EX2200 switch gets additional grounding
when you plug the power supply in the switch into a grounded AC power
outlet by using the AC power cord appropriate for your geographical location
(see AC Power Cord Specifications for EX2200 Switches on page 80).

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

123

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

To connect AC power to the switch:


1.

Squeeze the two sides of the power cord retainer clip and insert the L-shaped ends
of the wire clip into the holes in the bracket on each side of the AC power cord inlet
on the rear panel (Figure 47 on page 124).
The power cord retainer clip extends out of the chassis by 3 in.

2. Locate the power cord or cords shipped with the switch; the cords have plugs

appropriate for your geographical location. See AC Power Cord Specifications for
EX2200 Switches on page 80.

WARNING: Ensure that the power cord does not drape where people can
trip on it or block access to switch components.

3. Insert the coupler end of the power cord into the AC power cord inlet on the rear panel.
4. Push the power cord into the slot in the adjustment nut of the power cord retainer

clip. Turn the nut until it is tight against the base of the coupler and the slot in the nut
is turned 90 from the top of the switch (see Figure 48 on page 125).
5. If the AC power source outlet has a power switch, set it to the OFF (0) position.
6. Insert the power cord plug into an AC power source outlet.
7. If the AC power source outlet has a power switch, set it to the ON (|) position.

Retainer clip
Adjustment nut

g027013

Figure 47: Connecting an AC Power Cord Retainer Clip to the AC Power


Cord Inlet on an EX2200 Switch

NOTE: The retainer brackets on your switch might be above and below the
power inlet rather than on either side.

124

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 10: Connecting the Switch

Figure 48: Connecting an AC Power Cord to the AC Power Cord Inlet on


an EX2200 Switch

g027014

Tighten
adjustment nut.

Related
Documentation

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Power Supply in EX2200 Switches on page 18

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch


The power supply is built in along the rear panel.

WARNING: DC-powered switches are intended for installation only in a


restricted access location.

Before you begin connecting DC power to the switch, ensure that you have connected
the switch chassis to earth ground.

CAUTION: Before you connect power to the switch, a licensed electrician


must attach a cable lug to the grounding and power cables that you supply.
A cable with an incorrectly attached lug can damage the switch (for example,
by causing a short circuit).
To meet safety and electromagnetic interference (EMI) requirements and
to ensure proper operation, you must connect the switch to earth ground
before you connect them to power. For installations that require a separate
grounding conductor to the chassis, use the protective earthing terminal on
the switch chassis to connect to the earth ground. For instructions on
connecting earth ground, see Connecting Earth Ground to an EX Series
Switch on page 117.

NOTE: Grounding is required for DC systems and recommended for AC


systems. An AC-powered switch gets additional grounding when you plug
the power supply in the switch into a grounded AC power outlet by using the
AC power cord appropriate for your geographical location.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

125

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

DC power source cables (14 AWG) with ring lug (Molex 0190700067 or equivalent)
(not provided) attached to them by a licensed electrician

Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 2

To connect DC power to the switch:


1.

Ensure that the input circuit breaker is open so that the cable leads will not become
active while you are connecting DC power.

NOTE: The DC power supply in the switch has four terminals labeled A+,
B+, A, and B for connecting DC power source cables labeled
positive (+) and negative (). The terminals are covered by a clear plastic
cover.

NOTE: The A+ and B+ terminals are referred to as +RTN and A and B


terminals are referred to as 48 V in DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning
on page 208 and DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203.

2. Grasp the plastic cover in the middle, gently flex it outwards, and pull it out. Save the

cover.
3. Remove the screws on the terminals using the screwdriver. Save the screws.

WARNING: Ensure that the power cables do not block access to switch
components or drape where people can trip on them.

4. Connect the power supply to the power sources. Secure power source cables to the

power supply by screwing the ring lugs attached to the cables to the appropriate
terminals by using the screw from the terminals (see Figure 49 on page 126).

Figure 49: Securing Ring Lugs to the Terminals on the DC Power Supply

g021215

DC power terminals:
A- B+ A+
B-

DC power source cable


with lug attached

126

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 10: Connecting the Switch

To connect the power supply to a power source:


a. Secure the ring lug of the positive (+) DC power source cable to the A+ or B+

terminal on the DC power supply.


b. Secure the ring lug of the negative () DC power source cable to the A or B

terminal on the DC power supply.


c. Tighten the screws on the power supply terminals until snug using the screwdriver.

Do not overtightenapply between 8 in.-lb (0.9 Nm) and 9 in.-lb (1.02 Nm) of
torque to the screws.

To connect the power supply to two power sources:


a. Secure the ring lug of the positive (+) DC power source cable from the first DC

power source to the A+ terminal on the power supply.


b. Secure the ring lug of the negative () DC power source cable from the first DC

power source to the A terminal on the power supply.


c. Secure the ring lug of the positive (+) DC power source cable from the second

DC power source to the B+ terminal on the power supply.


d. Secure the ring lug of the negative () DC power source cable from the second

DC power source to the B terminal on the power supply.


e. Tighten the screws on the power supply terminals on both the power supplies

until snug using the screwdriver. Do not overtightenapply between 8 in.-lb


(0.9 Nm) and 9 in.-lb (1.02 Nm) of torque to the screws.
5. Hook the plastic cover on one side of the terminal block and gently flex it inwards to

hook it on the other side also.


6. Close the input circuit breaker.

Related
Documentation

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Power Supply in EX2200 Switches on page 18

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band Management


This topic applies to multiple hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which
includes switches and the XRE200 External Routing Engine.
You can monitor and manage these devices by using a dedicated management channel.
Each device has a management port with an RJ-45 connector for out-of-band
management. Use the management port to connect the EX Series switch or external
Routing Engine to the management device.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

127

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Ensure that you have an Ethernet cable with an RJ-45 connector available. One such
cable is provided with the device. Figure 50 on page 128 shows the RJ-45 connector of
the Ethernet cable supplied with the device.

Figure 50: Ethernet Cable Connector

To connect a device to a network for out-of-band management (see Figure 51 on page 129):
1.

Connect one end of the Ethernet cable to the management port (labeled MGMT or
ETHERNET) on the device.
For the location of the MGMT or ETHERNET port on different devices:

See EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3.

See Rear Panel of an EX3200 Switch.

See Rear Panel of an EX3300 Switch.

See Rear Panel of an EX4200 Switch.

See EX4300 Switches Hardware Overview

See Front Panel of an EX4500 Switch.

See EX4550 Switches Hardware Overview

See Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX6200 Switch.

See Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX8208 Switch.

See Routing Engine (RE) Module in an EX8216 Switch.

See Front Panel of an XRE200 External Routing Engine.

2. Connect the other end of the Ethernet cable to the management device.

128

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 10: Connecting the Switch

Figure 51: Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band


Management

Related
Documentation

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console on page 129

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX2200 Switch on page 25

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX3200 Switch

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX3300 Switch

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX4200 Switch

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX4300 Switch

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX4500 Switch

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX4550 Switch

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX6200 Switch

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX8200 Switch

Management Port Connector Pinout Information for an XRE200 External Routing Engine

Cables Connecting the EX6200 Switch to Management Devices

Cables Connecting the EX8200 Switch to Management Devices

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console


This topic applies to multiple hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which
includes switches and the XRE200 External Routing Engine.
You can configure and manage these devices by using a dedicated console. Every device
has a console port with an RJ-45 connector. Use the console port to connect the device
to the management console or to a console server. The console port accepts a cable
with an RJ-45 connector.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

129

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Ensure that you have an Ethernet cable with an RJ-45 connector available. An RJ-45
cable and an RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port adapter are supplied with the device.
Figure 52 on page 130 shows the RJ-45 connector of the Ethernet cable supplied with the
device.

Figure 52: Ethernet Cable Connector

NOTE: If your laptop or PC does not have a DB-9 male connector pin and you
want to connect your laptop or PC directly to the device, use a combination
of the RJ-45 to DB-9 female adapter supplied with the device and a USB to
DB-9 male adapter. You must provide the USB to DB-9 male adapter.

To connect the device to a management console (see Figure 53 on page 131 and
Figure 54 on page 131):
1.

Connect one end of the Ethernet cable into the console port (labeled CON, CONSOLE,
or CON1) on the device.
For the location of the CON/CONSOLE port on different devices:

See EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3.

See Rear Panel of an EX3200 Switch.

See Rear Panel of an EX3300 Switch.

See Rear Panel of an EX4200 Switch.

See EX4300 Switches Hardware Overview

See Front Panel of an EX4500 Switch.

See EX4550 Switches Hardware Overview

See Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX6200 Switch.

See Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX8208 Switch.

See Routing Engine (RE) Module in an EX8216 Switch.

See Front Panel of an XRE200 External Routing Engine.

2. Connect the other end of the Ethernet cable into the console server (see

Figure 53 on page 131) or management console (see Figure 54 on page 131).


To configure the device from the management console, see Connecting and Configuring
an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139 or Connecting and Configuring an EX
Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142.

130

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 10: Connecting the Switch

NOTE: EX2200-24T-4G-DC switches do not support switch connection and


configuration through the J-Web interface.

Figure 53: Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console


Through a Console Server

Figure 54: Connecting an EX Series Switch Directly to a Management


Console

Related
Documentation

Configuring the Console Port Type (CLI Procedure)

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 127

Console Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX Series Switch on page 23

Cables Connecting the EX6200 Switch to Management Devices

Cables Connecting the EX8200 Switch to Management Devices

Connecting an EX2200 Switch to a Management Console Using Mini-USB Type-B


Console Port
You can configure and manage EX2200C switches by using the RJ-45 console port or
the Mini-USB Type-B console port. However, the console input will be active only on one
port at a time, that is, only one port will be set active at a time.
If your laptop or PC does not have a DB-9 male connector pin or RJ-45 connector pin,
you can connect your laptop or PC directly to an EX2200C switch using a mini-USB
cable that has a Standard-A USB connector on one end and a Mini-USB Type-B (5 pin)
connector on the other end.
This section describes the process of connecting an EX2200C switch to the management
console using the Mini-USB Type-B console port.
For information about configuring and managing an EX2200C switch using the RJ-45
console port, see Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Management Console on page 129.
Before you begin connecting an EX2200C switch using Mini-USB Type-B console port:

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

131

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Ensure that the USB to Serial driver is installed on the host machine. You can download
the driver from https://webdownload.juniper.net/swdl/dl/secure/site/1/record/5029.html
.

Ensure that the hyper terminal properties of the console server or laptop are set as
follows:

Baud rate9600

Flow controlNone

Data8

ParityNone

Stop bits1

DCD stateDisregard

Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

1 mini-USB cable with Standard-A and Mini-USB Type- B (5-pin) connectors (not
provided).

To connect the switch to the console using Mini-USB Type-B console port:
1.

Connect the Standard-A connector of the mini-USB cable to the host machine (PC
or Laptop).

2. Connect the Mini-USB Type-B (5-pin) connector of the mini-USB cable to the Mini-USB

Type-B console port (labeled CON) on the switch.


3. Set the Mini-USB Type-B console port as the active console port by using the command

port-type.

By default, the RJ-45 port is set as an active console port and the Mini-USB Type-B
port is the passive console port. For information about configuring the console port
type, see Configuring the Console Port Type (CLI Procedure).
4. Reboot the switch.
5. Reboot the switch.

Once the connection is established, you will get the control and the log messages on the
Mini-USB Type-B console port.
Related
Documentation

132

Configuring the Console Port Type (CLI Procedure)

Connecting an EX Series Switch to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 127

Console Port Connector Pinout Information for an EX Series Switch on page 23

Cables Connecting the EX6200 Switch to Management Devices

Cables Connecting the EX8200 Switch to Management Devices

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 10: Connecting the Switch

Connecting a Fiber-Optic Cable to an EX Series Switch


EX Series switches support optical transceivers, which are field-replaceable units (FRUs).
You can connect fiber-optic cables to these transceivers.
Before you begin connecting a fiber-optic cable to an optical transceiver installed in an
EX Series switch, ensure that you have taken the necessary precautions for safe handling
of lasers (see Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches
on page 175).
To connect a fiber-optic cable to an optical transceiver installed in an EX Series switch:

WARNING: Do not look directly into a fiber-optic transceiver or into the ends
of fiber-optic cables. Fiber-optic transceivers and fiber-optic cables connected
to transceivers emit laser light that can damage your eyes.

1.

If the fiber-optic cable connector is covered with a rubber safety cap, remove the cap.
Save the cap.

2. Remove the rubber safety cap from the optical transceiver. Save the cap.
3. Insert the cable connector into the optical transceiver (see Figure 55 on page 133).

Figure 55: Connecting a Fiber-Optic Cable to an Optical Transceiver


Installed in an EX Series Switch

g027016

Transceiver

Fiber-optic cable

4. Secure the cables so that they are not supporting their own weight. Place excess cable

out of the way in a neatly coiled loop. Placing fasteners on a loop helps cables maintain
their shape.

CAUTION: Do not bend fiber-optic cables beyond their minimum bend


radius. An arc smaller than a few inches in diameter can damage the cables
and cause problems that are difficult to diagnose.
Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do not allow
fastened loops of cables to dangle, which stresses the cables at the
fastening point.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

133

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Related
Documentation

134

Disconnecting a Fiber-Optic Cable from an EX Series Switch on page 151

Installing a Transceiver in an EX Series Switch on page 113

Maintaining Fiber-Optic Cables in EX Series Switches on page 155

Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX Series Switches

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 11

Performing Initial Configuration

EX2200 Switch Default Configuration on page 135

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

EX2200 Switch Default Configuration


Each EX Series switch is programmed with a factory default configuration that contains
the values set for each configuration parameter when a switch is shipped. The default
configuration file for an EX2200 switch configures Ethernet switching and storm control
on all interfaces, configures Power over Ethernet (PoE) on all interfaces of models that
provide PoE, and enables the LLDP, LLDP-MED, and RSTP protocols and IGMP snooping.
When you commit changes to the configuration, a new configuration file is created that
becomes the active configuration. You can always revert to the factory default
configurationbecause an EX2200 switch does not have an LCD panel, use the CLI
commands to revert to the factory default configuration. See Reverting to the Default
Factory Configuration for the EX Series Switch.
The following factory default configuration file is for an EX2200 switch with 24 ports, all
of which have PoE capability:

NOTE: The factory default configuration file is different for different EX2200
switch models.
The number of interfaces in the default configuration file depends on the
number of ports in the EX2200 switch.
The poe stanza does not appear for models without PoE.
Uplink ports for the EX2200 switches except the EX2200-C models will be
listed as ge-0/1/0 to ge-0/1/3 and for the EX2200-C switches as ge-0/1/0 to
ge-0/1/1.

system {
syslog {
user * {
any emergency;

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

135

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

}
file messages {
any notice;
authorization info;
}
file interactive-commands {
interactive-commands any;
}
}
commit {
factory-settings {
reset-chassis-lcd-menu;
reset-virtual-chassis-configuration;
}
}
}
interfaces {
ge-0/0/0 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/1 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/2 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/3 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/4 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/5 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/6 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/7 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}

136

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 11: Performing Initial Configuration

}
ge-0/0/8 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/9 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/10 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/11 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/12 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/13 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/14 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/15 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/16 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/17 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/18 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

137

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

ge-0/0/19 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/20 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/21 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/22 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/0/23 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/1/0 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/1/1 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/1/2 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
ge-0/1/3 {
unit 0 {
family ethernet-switching;
}
}
}
protocols {
igmp-snooping {
vlan all;
}
rstp;
lldp {
interface all;
}
lldp-med {
interface all;

138

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 11: Performing Initial Configuration

}
}
ethernet-switching-options {
storm-control {
interface all;
}
}

Related
Documentation

Configuration Files Terms

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Understanding Configuration Files for EX Series Switches

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure)


There are two ways to connect and configure an EX Series switch: one method is through
the console by using the command-line interface (CLI) and the other is by using the
J-Web interface.

NOTE: EX2200-24T-4G-DC switches do not support switch connection and


configuration through the J-Web interface.

This topic describes the CLI procedure.

NOTE: To run the ezsetup script, the switch must have the factory default
configuration as the active configuration. If you have configured anything on
the switch and want to run ezsetup, revert to the factory default configuration.
See Reverting to the Default Factory Configuration for the EX Series Switch.

Using the CLI, set the following parameter values in the console server or PC:

Baud rate9600

Flow controlNone

Data8

ParityNone

Stop bits1

DCD stateDisregard

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

139

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

To connect and configure the switch from the console by using the CLI:
1.

Connect the console port to a laptop or PC by using the RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port
adapter. The RJ-45 cable and RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port adapter are supplied with the
switch.
For the location of the console port on different EX Series switches:

See EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3.

See Rear Panel of an EX3200 Switch.

See Rear Panel of an EX3300 Switch.

See Rear Panel of an EX4200 Switch.

See EX4300 Switches Hardware Overview

See Front Panel of an EX4500 Switch.

See EX4550 Switches Hardware Overview

See Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX6200 Switch.

See Switch Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) Module in an EX8208 Switch.

See Routing Engine (RE) Module in an EX8216 Switch.

NOTE: In EX2200-C, EX4300, and EX4550 switches, you can also use
the Mini-USB Type-B console port to connect to a laptop or PC.

For EX2200-C switches, see Connecting an EX2200 Switch to a


Management Console Using Mini-USB Type-B Console Port on page 131.

For EX4300 switches, see Connecting an EX4300 Switch to a


Management Console Using the Mini-USB Type-B Console Port.

For EX4550 switches, see Connecting an EX4550 Switch to a


Management Console Using the Mini-USB Type-B Console Port.

2. At the Junos OS shell prompt root%, type ezsetup.


3. Enter the hostname. This is optional.
4. Enter the root password you plan to use for this device. You are prompted to re-enter

the root password.


5. Enter yes to enable services like Telnet and SSH. By default, Telnet is not enabled

and SSH is enabled.

NOTE: When Telnet is enabled, you will not be able to log in to an EX Series
switch through Telnet by using root credentials. Root login is allowed only
for SSH access.

6. Use the Management Options page to select the management scenario:

140

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 11: Performing Initial Configuration

NOTE: On EX4500, EX6200, and EX8200 switches, only the out-of-band


management option is available.

Configure in-band management. In in-band management, you configure a network


interface or an uplink module (expansion module) interface as the management
interface and connect it to the management device.
In this scenario, you have the following two options:

Use the default VLAN.

Create a new VLANIf you select this option, you are prompted to specify the
VLAN name, VLAN ID, management IP address, and default gateway. Select the
ports that must be part of this VLAN.

Configure out-of-band management. In out-of-band management, you use a


dedicated management channel (MGMT port) to connect to the management
device. Specify the IP address and gateway of the management interface. Use this
IP address to connect to the switch.

7. Specify the SNMP read community, location, and contact to configure SNMP

parameters. These parameters are optional.


8. Specify the system date and time. Select the time zone from the list. These options

are optional.
9. The configured parameters are displayed. Enter yes to commit the configuration. The

configuration is committed as the active configuration for the switch.


10. (For EX4500 switches only) Enter the operational mode command request chassis

pic-mode intraconnect to set the PIC mode to intraconnect.


You can now log in with the CLI or the J-Web interface to continue configuring the switch.
If you use the J-Web interface to continue configuring the switch, the Web session is
redirected to the new management IP address. If the connection cannot be made, the
J-Web interface displays instructions for starting a J-Web session.
Related
Documentation

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure) on page 142

Installing and Connecting an EX2200 Switch on page 85

Installing and Connecting an EX3200 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX3300 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX4200 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX4300 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX4550 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX4500 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX6210 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX8208 Switch

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

141

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Installing and Connecting an EX8216 Switch

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (J-Web Procedure)


There are two ways to connect and configure an EX Series switch: one method is through
the console by using the command-line interface (CLI) and the other is by using the
J-Web interface.

NOTE: EX2200-24T-4G-DC switches do not support switch connection and


configuration through J-Web procedure.

This topic describes the J-Web procedure.

NOTE: Before you begin the configuration, enable a DHCP client on the
management PC that you will connect to the switch so that the PC can obtain
an IP address dynamically.

NOTE: Read the following steps before you begin the configuration. You
must complete the initial configuration by using EZSetup within 10 minutes.
The switch exits EZSetup after 10 minutes and reverts to the factory default
configuration, and the PC loses connectivity to the switch.

142

EX2200 and EX2200-C switchThe LEDs on the network ports on the


front panel blink when the switch is in the initial setup mode.

EX3200, EX3300, EX4200, EX4300, EX4500, EX4550, EX6200, or EX8200


switchThe LCD panel displays a count-down timer when the switch is in
initial setup mode.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 11: Performing Initial Configuration

To connect and configure the switch by using the J-Web interface:


1.

Transition the switch into initial setup mode:

EX2200 and EX2200-C switchPress the mode button located on the lower right
corner of the front panel for 10 seconds.

EX3200, EX3300, EX4200, EX4300, EX4500, EX4550, EX6200, or EX8200


switchUse the Menu and Enter buttons located to the right of the LCD panel (see
Figure 56 on page 143 or Figure 57 on page 143):

Figure 56: LCD Panel in an EX3200, EX4200, EX4500, EX4550, or EX8200


Switch

Figure 57: LCD Panel in an EX4300 Switch

1 LCD panel

3 LCD panel Menu button

2 LCD panel Enter button

4 Chassis status LEDs

1.

Press the Menu button until you see MAINTENANCE MENU. Then press the Enter
button.

2. Press Menu until you see ENTER EZSetup. Then press Enter.

If EZSetup does not appear as an option in the menu, select Factory Default to
return the switch to the factory default configuration. EZSetup is displayed in
the menu of standalone switches only when a switch is set to the factory default
configuration.
3. Press Enter to confirm setup and continue with EZSetup.
2. Connect the Ethernet cable from the Ethernet port on the PC to the switch.

EX2200, EX3200, or EX4200 switchConnect the cable to port 0 (ge-0/0/0) on


the front panel of the switch.

EX3300, EX4500, or EX4550 switchConnect the cable to the port labeled MGMT
on the front panel (LCD panel side) of the switch.

EX4300 switchConnect the cable to the port labeled MGMT on the rear panel of
the switch.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

143

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

EX6200 switchConnect the cable to one of the ports labeled MGMT on the Switch
Fabric and Routing Engine (SRE) module in slot 4 or 5 in an EX6210 switch.

EX8200 switchConnect the cable to the port labeled MGMT on the Switch Fabric
and Routing Engine (SRE) module in slot SRE0 in an EX8208 switch or on the
Routing Engine (RE) module in slot RE0 in an EX8216 switch.

These ports are configured as the DHCP server with the default IP address, 192.168.1.1.
The switch can assign an IP address to the management PC in the IP address range
192.168.1.2 through 192.168.1.253.
3. From the PC, open a Web browser, type http://192.168.1.1 in the address field, and

press Enter.
4. On the J-Web login page, type root as the username, leave the password field blank,

and click Login.


5. On the Introduction page, click Next.
6. On the Basic Settings page, modify the hostname, the root password, and date and

time settings:

Enter the hostname. This is optional.

Enter a password and reenter the password.

Specify the time zone.

Synchronize the date and time settings of the switch with the management PC or
set them manually by selecting the appropriate option button. This is optional.

Click Next.
7. Use the Management Options page to select the management scenario:

NOTE: On EX4500, EX6210, and EX8200 switches, only the out-of-band


management option is available.

In-band ManagementUse VLAN 'default' for management.

Select this option to configure all data interfaces as members of the default VLAN.
Click Next. Specify the management IP address and the default gateway for the
default VLAN.

In-band ManagementCreate new VLAN for management.

Select this option to create a management VLAN. Click Next. Specify the VLAN
name, VLAN ID, member interfaces, management IP address, and default gateway
for the new VLAN.

Out-of-band ManagementConfigure management port.

Select this option to configure only the management interface. Click Next. Specify
the IP address and default gateway for the management interface.
8. Click Next.

144

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 11: Performing Initial Configuration

9. On the Manage Access page, you can select options to enable Telnet, SSH, and SNMP

services. For SNMP, you can configure the read community, location, and contact.
10. Click Next. The Summary screen displays the configured settings.
11. Click Finish. The configuration is committed as the active switch configuration.

NOTE: After the configuration is committed, the connectivity between


the PC and the switch might be lost. To renew the connection, release and
renew the IP address by executing the appropriate commands on the
management PC or by removing and reinserting the Ethernet cable.

12. (For EX4500 switches only) In the CLI, enter the request chassis pic-mode

intraconnect operational mode command to set the PIC mode to intraconnect.


You can now log in by using the CLI or the J-Web interface to continue configuring the
switch.
If you use the J-Web interface to continue configuring the switch, the Web session is
redirected to the new management IP address. If the connection cannot be made, the
J-Web interface displays instructions for starting a J-Web session.
Related
Documentation

Connecting and Configuring an EX Series Switch (CLI Procedure) on page 139

Installing and Connecting an EX2200 Switch on page 85

Installing and Connecting an EX3200 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX3300 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX4200 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX4300 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX4500 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX4550 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX6210 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX8208 Switch

Installing and Connecting an EX8216 Switch

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

145

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

146

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

PART 4

Removing Switch Components

Removing Switch Components on page 149

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

147

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

148

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 12

Removing Switch Components

Removing a Transceiver from an EX Series Switch on page 149

Disconnecting a Fiber-Optic Cable from an EX Series Switch on page 151

Removing a Transceiver from an EX Series Switch


The transceivers for EX Series switches are hot-removable and hot-insertable
field-replaceable units (FRUs): You can remove and replace them without powering off
the switch or disrupting switch functions.

NOTE: After you remove a transceiver or when you change the media-type
configuration, wait for 6 seconds for the interface to display the operational
commands.

Before you begin removing a transceiver from an EX Series switch, ensure that you have
taken the necessary precautions for safe handling of lasers (see Laser and LED Safety
Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches on page 175).
Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

An antistatic bag or an antistatic mat

Rubber safety caps to cover the transceiver and fiber-optic cable connector

A dust cover to cover the port

Figure 58 on page 151 shows how to remove a QSFP+ transceiver. The procedure is the
same for all types of transceivers except the CFP transceivers.
To remove a transceiver from an EX Series switch:
1.

Place the antistatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface.

2. Label the cable connected to the transceiver so that you can reconnect it correctly.

WARNING: Do not look directly into a fiber-optic transceiver or into the


ends of fiber-optic cables. Fiber-optic transceivers and fiber-optic cables
connected to transceivers emit laser light that can damage your eyes.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

149

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

WARNING: Do not leave a fiber-optic transceiver uncovered except when


inserting or removing a cable. The rubber safety cap keeps the port clean
and prevents accidental exposure to laser light.

CAUTION: Do not bend fiber-optic cables beyond their minimum bend


radius. An arc smaller than a few inches in diameter can damage the cables
and cause problems that are difficult to diagnose.

3. Remove the cable connected to the transceiver (see Disconnecting a Fiber-Optic

Cable from an EX Series Switch on page 151). Cover the transceiver and the end of
each fiber-optic cable connector with a rubber safety cap immediately after
disconnecting the fiber-optic cables.
4. To remove an SFP, SFP+, XFP, or QSFP+ transceiver:
a. By using your fingers, pull open the ejector lever on the transceiver to unlock the

transceiver.

CAUTION: Before removing the transceiver, make sure you open the
ejector lever completely until you hear it click. This prevents damage
to the transceiver.

b. Grasp the transceiver ejector lever and gently slide the transceiver approximately

0.5 in. (1.3 cm) straight out of the port.

CAUTION: To prevent electrostatic discharge (ESD) damage to the


transceiver, do not touch the connector pins at the end of the
transceiver.

To remove a CFP transceiver:


a. Loosen the screws on the transceiver by using your fingers.
b. Grasp the screws on the transceiver and gently slide the transceiver approximately

0.5 in. (1.3 cm) straight out of the port.

CAUTION: To prevent electrostatic discharge (ESD) damage to the


transceiver, do not touch the connector pins at the end of the
transceiver.

5. By using your fingers, grasp the body of the transceiver and pull it straight out of the

port.

150

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 12: Removing Switch Components

6. Place the transceiver in the antistatic bag or on the antistatic mat placed on a flat,

stable surface.
7. Place the dust cover over the empty port.

Figure 58: Removing a Transceiver from an EX Series Switch

1 Ejector lever

Related
Documentation

Installing a Transceiver in an EX Series Switch on page 113

Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX Series Switches

Disconnecting a Fiber-Optic Cable from an EX Series Switch


EX Series switches have field-replaceable unit (FRU) optical transceivers to which you
can connect fiber-optic cables.
Before you begin disconnecting a fiber-optic cable from an optical transceiver installed
in an EX Series switch, ensure that you have taken the necessary precautions for safe
handling of lasers. See Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series
Switches on page 175.
Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

A rubber safety cap to cover the transceiver

A rubber safety cap to cover the fiber-optic cable connector

To disconnect a fiber-optic cable from an optical transceiver installed in the switch:


1.

Disable the port in which the transceiver is installed by issuing the following command:
[edit interfaces]
user@switch# set interface-name disable

WARNING: Do not look directly into a fiber-optic transceiver or into the


ends of fiber-optic cables. Fiber-optic transceivers and fiber-optic cables
connected to transceivers emit laser light that can damage your eyes.

2. Carefully unplug the fiber-optic cable connector from the transceiver.


3. Cover the transceiver with a rubber safety cap.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

151

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

WARNING: Do not leave a fiber-optic transceiver uncovered except when


inserting or removing a cable. The rubber safety cap keeps the port clean
and prevents accidental exposure to laser light.

4. Cover the fiber-optic cable connector with the rubber safety cap.

Related
Documentation

152

Connecting a Fiber-Optic Cable to an EX Series Switch on page 133

Removing a Transceiver from an EX Series Switch on page 149

Maintaining Fiber-Optic Cables in EX Series Switches on page 155

Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX Series Switches

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

PART 5

Switch and Component Maintenance

Routine Maintenance on page 155

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

153

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

154

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 13

Routine Maintenance

Maintaining Fiber-Optic Cables in EX Series Switches on page 155

Maintaining Fiber-Optic Cables in EX Series Switches


Fiber-optic cables connect to optical transceivers that are installed in EX Series switches.
To maintain fiber-optic cables:

When you unplug a fiber-optic cable from a transceiver, place rubber safety caps over
the transceiver and on the end of the cable.

Anchor fiber-optic cables to prevent stress on the connectors. When attaching a


fiber-optic cable to a transceiver, be sure to secure the fiber-optic cable so that it is
not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the floor. Never let a fiber-optic cable hang
free from the connector.

Avoid bending fiber-optic cables beyond their minimum bend radius. Bending fiber-optic
cables into arcs smaller than a few inches in diameter can damage the cables and
cause problems that are difficult to diagnose.

Frequent plugging and unplugging of fiber-optic cables in and out of optical instruments
can damage the instruments, which are expensive to repair. Attach a short fiber
extension to the optical equipment. Any wear and tear due to frequent plugging and
unplugging is then absorbed by the short fiber extension, which is easier and less
expensive to replace than the instruments.

Keep fiber-optic cable connections clean. Micro-deposits of oil and dust in the canal
of the transceiver or cable connector can cause loss of light, reduction in signal power,
and possibly intermittent problems with the optical connection.

To clean the transceiver canal, use an appropriate fiber-cleaning device such as


RIFOCS Fiber Optic Adaptor Cleaning Wands (part number 946). Follow the directions
in the cleaning kit you use.

After cleaning the transceiver, make sure that the connector tip of the fiber-optic
cable is clean. Use only an
approved alcohol-free fiber-optic cable cleaning kit such

as the Opptex Cletop-S Fiber Cleaner. Follow the directions in the cleaning kit you
use.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

155

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Related
Documentation

156

Connecting a Fiber-Optic Cable to an EX Series Switch on page 133

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches on page 175

Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX Series Switches

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

PART 6

Returning Hardware

Returning the Switch or Switch Components on page 159

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

157

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

158

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 14

Returning the Switch or Switch


Components

Returning an EX2200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement on page 159

Locating the Serial Number on an EX2200 Switch or Component on page 160

Contacting Customer Support to Obtain Return Materials Authorization for EX Series


Switches on page 161

Packing an EX2200 Switch or Component for Shipping on page 163

Returning an EX2200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement


If you need to return an EX2200 switch or hardware component to Juniper Networks for
repair or replacement, follow this procedure:
1.

Determine the serial number of the component. For instructions, see Locating the
Serial Number on an EX2200 Switch or Component on page 160.

2. Obtain an RMA number from JTAC as described in Contacting Customer Support to

Obtain Return Materials Authorization for EX Series Switches on page 161.

NOTE: Do not return any component to Juniper Networks unless you have
first obtained an RMA number. Juniper Networks reserves the right to
refuse shipments that do not have an RMA. Refused shipments are
returned to the customer through collect freight.

3. Pack the switch or component for shipping as described in Packing an EX2200 Switch

or Component for Shipping on page 163.


For more information about return and repair policies, see the customer support page at
http://www.juniper.net/support/guidelines.html .
Related
Documentation

EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

159

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Locating the Serial Number on an EX2200 Switch or Component


If you are returning an EX2200 switch or hardware component to Juniper Networks for
repair or replacement, you must locate the serial number of the switch or component.
You must provide the serial number to the Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center
(JTAC) when you contact them to obtain Return Materials Authorization (RMA).
If the switch is operational and you can access the CLI, you can list serial numbers for
the switch and for some components with a CLI command. If you do not have access to
the CLI or if the serial number for the component does not appear in the command output,
you can locate the serial number ID label on the physical switch (see Figure 59 on page 161)
or component.

NOTE: If you want to find the serial number on the physical switch component,
you will need to remove the component from the switch chassis, for which
you must have the required parts and tools available.

Listing the Switch and Components Details with the CLI on page 160

Locating the Chassis Serial Number ID Label on an EX2200 Switch on page 160

Listing the Switch and Components Details with the CLI


To list the switch and switch components and their serial numbers, enter the following
CLI command:
user@switch> show chassis hardware
Hardware inventory:
Item
Version Part number
Chassis
Routing Engine 0 REV 2A
750-026464
FPC 0
REV 2A
750-026464
CPU
BUILTIN
PIC 0
BUILTIN
PIC 1
REV 2A
750-026464
Power Supply 0
Fan Tray

Serial number
CV0209096579
CV0209096579
CV0209096579
BUILTIN
BUILTIN
CV0209096579

Description
EX2200-24P-4G
EX2200-24P-4G, POE
EX2200-24P-4G, POE
FPC CPU
24x 10/100/1000 Base-T
4x GE SFP
PS 550W AC
Fan Tray

Locating the Chassis Serial Number ID Label on an EX2200 Switch


EX2200 switches have serial number ID labels located on the rear panel of the chassis
(see Figure 59 on page 161).

160

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 14: Returning the Switch or Switch Components

Figure 59: Location of the Serial Number ID Label on EX2200 Switches


Serial number ID label
SN: CT0209520001

750-026464 REV: X3

Mfg. Date
20090227

MAC: 00:23:9C:oE:19:00
MADE IN CHINA

Related
Documentation

g027011

EX2200-24-4G REV: X1

Contacting Customer Support to Obtain Return Materials Authorization for EX Series


Switches on page 161

Returning an EX2200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement on page 159

Contacting Customer Support to Obtain Return Materials Authorization for EX Series


Switches
If you are returning a switch or hardware component to Juniper Networks for repair or
replacement, obtain a Return Materials Authorization (RMA) from Juniper Networks
Technical Assistance Center (JTAC).
After locating the serial number of the switch or hardware component you want to return,
open a Case with Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center (JTAC) on the Web or
by telephone.
For instructions on locating the serial number of the switch or hardware component you
want to return:

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX2200 Switch or Component on page 160

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX3200 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX3300 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX4200 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX4300 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX4500 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX4550 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX6200 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX8200 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX9204 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX9208 Switch or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX9214 Switch or Component

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

161

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

See Locating the Serial Number on an XRE200 External Routing Engine or Component

See Locating the Serial Number on an EX Series Redundant Power System or Redundant
Power System Components

Before you request an RMA from JTAC, be prepared to provide the following information:

Your existing case number, if you have one

Serial number of the component

Your name, organization name, telephone number, fax number, and shipping address

Details of the failure or problem

Type of activity being performed on the switch when the problem occurred

Configuration data displayed by one or more show commands

You can contact JTAC 24 hours a day, seven days a week on the Web or by telephone:

Case Manager at CSC: http://www.juniper.net/cm/

Telephone: +1-888-314-JTAC1-888-314-5822, toll free in U.S., Canada, and Mexico

NOTE: For international or direct-dial options in countries without toll free


numbers, see http://www.juniper.net/support/requesting-support.html .

If you are contacting JTAC by telephone, enter your 11-digit case number followed by the
pound (#) key for an existing case, or press the star (*) key to be routed to the next
available support engineer.
The support representative validates your request and issues an RMA number for return
of the component.
Related
Documentation

162

Packing an EX2200 Switch or Component for Shipping on page 163

Packing an EX3200 Switch or Component for Shipping

Packing an EX3300 Switch or Component for Shipping

Packing an EX4200 Switch or Component for Shipping

Packing an EX4200 Switch or Component for Shipping

Packing an EX4300 Switch or Component for Shipping

Packing an EX4500 Switch or Component for Shipping

Packing an EX4550 Switch or Component for Shipping

Packing an EX6200 Switch or Component

Packing an EX8200 Switch or Component

Packing an EX9200 Switch or Component

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 14: Returning the Switch or Switch Components

Packing an EX Series Redundant Power System or Redundant Power System Components


for Shipping

Returning an EX2200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement on page 159

Returning an EX3200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX3300 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX4200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX4300 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX4500 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX4550 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX6200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX8200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX9200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement

Returning an EX Series RPS or RPS Component for Repair or Replacement

Packing an EX2200 Switch or Component for Shipping


If you are returning an EX2200 switch or component to Juniper Networks for repair or
replacement, pack the item as described in this topic.
Before you begin, ensure that you have retrieved the original shipping carton and packing
materials. Contact your JTAC representative if you do not have these materials, to learn
about approved packing materials. See Contacting Customer Support to Obtain Return
Materials Authorization for EX Series Switches on page 161.
Ensure that you have the following parts and tools available:

Antistatic bag, one for each switch or component

Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 2

This topic describes:

Packing a Switch for Shipping on page 164

Packing Switch Components for Shipping on page 164

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

163

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Packing a Switch for Shipping


To pack a switch for shipping:
1.

On the console or other management device connected to the switch, enter the CLI
operational mode and issue the following command to shut down the switch software:
user@switch> request system halt

Wait until a message appears on the console confirming that the operating system
has halted.
2. Disconnect power from the switch by performing one of the following:

If the power source outlet has a power switch, set it to the OFF (0) position.

If the power source outlet does not have a power switch, gently pull out the male
end of the power cord connected to the power source outlet.

3. Remove the cables that connect the switch to all external devices. See Disconnecting

a Fiber-Optic Cable from an EX Series Switch on page 151.


4. Remove all optical transceivers installed in the switch. See Removing a Transceiver

from an EX Series Switch on page 149.


5. If the switch is mounted on a wall or on two posts, have one person hold the switch

while another person unscrews and removes the mounting screws.


6. Use the Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 2 to remove the screws.
7. Remove the switch from the wall, rack, cabinet, or desk and place the switch in an

antistatic bag.
8. Slip on the end caps of the packaging foam on both sides of the switch.
9. Place the switch in the shipping carton.
10. Place the packing foam on top of and around the switch.
11. If you are returning accessories or FRUs with the switch, pack them as instructed in

Packing Switch Components for Shipping on page 164.


12. Close the top of the cardboard carton and seal it with packing tape.
13. Write the RMA number on the exterior of the carton to ensure proper tracking.

Packing Switch Components for Shipping


To pack and ship switch components:

164

Place individual components in antistatic bags.

Ensure that the components are adequately protected with packing materials and
packed so that the pieces are prevented from moving around inside the carton.

Close the top of the cardboard shipping carton and seal it with packing tape.

Write the RMA number on the exterior of the carton to ensure proper tracking.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 14: Returning the Switch or Switch Components

Related
Documentation

Returning an EX2200 Switch or Component for Repair or Replacement on page 159

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

165

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

166

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

PART 7

Safety Information

General Safety Information on page 169

Radiation and Laser Warnings on page 175

Installation and Maintenance Safety Information on page 181

Power and Electrical Safety Information on page 197

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

167

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

168

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 15

General Safety Information

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Definitions of Safety Warning Levels on page 170

Fire Safety Requirements on page 172

Qualified Personnel Warning on page 173

Warning Statement for Norway and Sweden on page 174

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.
The following guidelines help ensure your safety and protect the device from damage.
The list of guidelines might not address all potentially hazardous situations in your working
environment, so be alert and exercise good judgment at all times.

Perform only the procedures explicitly described in the hardware documentation for
this device. Make sure that only authorized service personnel perform other system
services.

Keep the area around the device clear and free from dust before, during, and after
installation.

Keep tools away from areas where people could trip over them while walking.

Do not wear loose clothing or jewelry, such as rings, bracelets, or chains, which could
become caught in the device.

Wear safety glasses if you are working under any conditions that could be hazardous
to your eyes.

Do not perform any actions that create a potential hazard to people or make the
equipment unsafe.

Never attempt to lift an object that is too heavy for one person to handle.

Never install or manipulate wiring during electrical storms.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

169

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Related
Documentation

Never install electrical jacks in wet locations unless the jacks are specifically designed
for wet environments.

Operate the device only when it is properly grounded.

Ensure that the separate protective earthing terminal provided on this device is
permanently connected to earth.

Replace fuses only with fuses of the same type and rating.

Do not open or remove chassis covers or sheet-metal parts unless instructions are
provided in the hardware documentation for this device. Such an action could cause
severe electrical shock.

Do not push or force any objects through any opening in the chassis frame. Such an
action could result in electrical shock or fire.

Avoid spilling liquid onto the chassis or onto any device component. Such an action
could cause electrical shock or damage the device.

Avoid touching uninsulated electrical wires or terminals that have not been
disconnected from their power source. Such an action could cause electrical shock.

Always ensure that all modules, power supplies, and cover panels are fully inserted
and that the installation screws are fully tightened.

AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 200

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

Maintenance and Operational Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 190

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Definitions of Safety Warning Levels


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.
The documentation uses the following levels of safety warnings (there are two Warning
formats):

NOTE: You might find this information helpful in a particular situation, or you
might overlook this important information if it was not highlighted in a Note.

170

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 15: General Safety Information

CAUTION: You need to observe the specified guidelines to prevent minor


injury or discomfort to you or severe damage to the device.

WARNING: This symbol alerts you to the risk of personal injury from a laser.

WARNING: This symbol means danger. You are in a situation that could cause
bodily injury. Before you work on any equipment, be aware of the hazards
involved with electrical circuitry and be familiar with standard practices for
preventing accidents.
Waarschuwing Dit waarschuwingssymbool betekent gevaar. U verkeert in
een situatie die lichamelijk letsel kan veroorzaken. Voordat u aan enige
apparatuur gaat werken, dient u zich bewust te zijn van de bij elektrische
schakelingen betrokken risico's en dient u op de hoogte te zijn van standaard
maatregelen om ongelukken te voorkomen.
Varoitus Tm varoitusmerkki merkitsee vaaraa. Olet tilanteessa, joka voi
johtaa ruumiinvammaan. Ennen kuin tyskentelet minkn laitteiston parissa,
ota selv shkkytkentihin liittyvist vaaroista ja tavanomaisista
onnettomuuksien ehkisykeinoista.
Attention Ce symbole d'avertissement indique un danger. Vous vous trouvez
dans une situation pouvant causer des blessures ou des dommages corporels.
Avant de travailler sur un quipement, soyez conscient des dangers poss
par les circuits lectriques et familiarisez-vous avec les procdures
couramment utilises pour viter les accidents.
Warnung Dieses Warnsymbol bedeutet Gefahr. Sie befinden sich in einer
Situation, die zu einer Krperverletzung fhren knnte. Bevor Sie mit der
Arbeit an irgendeinem Gert beginnen, seien Sie sich der mit elektrischen
Stromkreisen verbundenen Gefahren und der Standardpraktiken zur
Vermeidung von Unfllen bewut.
Avvertenza Questo simbolo di avvertenza indica un pericolo. La situazione
potrebbe causare infortuni alle persone. Prima di lavorare su qualsiasi
apparecchiatura, occorre conoscere i pericoli relativi ai circuiti elettrici ed
essere al corrente delle pratiche standard per la prevenzione di incidenti.
Advarsel Dette varselsymbolet betyr fare. Du befinner deg i en situasjon som
kan fre til personskade. Fr du utfrer arbeid p utstyr, m du vare
oppmerksom p de faremomentene som elektriske kretser innebrer, samt
gjre deg kjent med vanlig praksis nr det gjelder unng ulykker.
Aviso Este smbolo de aviso indica perigo. Encontra-se numa situao que
lhe poder causar danos fsicos. Antes de comear a trabalhar com qualquer
equipamento, familiarize-se com os perigos relacionados com circuitos

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

171

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

elctricos, e com quaisquer prticas comuns que possam prevenir possveis


acidentes.
Atencin! Este smbolo de aviso significa peligro. Existe riesgo para su
integridad fsica. Antes de manipular cualquier equipo, considerar los riesgos
que entraa la corriente elctrica y familiarizarse con los procedimientos
estndar de prevencin de accidentes.
Varning! Denna varningssymbol signalerar fara. Du befinner dig i en situation
som kan leda till personskada. Innan du utfr arbete p ngon utrustning
mste du vara medveten om farorna med elkretsar och knna till vanligt
frfarande fr att frebygga skador.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Maintenance and Operational Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 190

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches on page 175

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for the QFX Series

Warning Statement for Norway and Sweden on page 174

Fire Safety Requirements


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.
In the event of a fire emergency involving switches and other network equipment, the
safety of people is the primary concern. You should establish procedures for protecting
people in the event of a fire emergency, provide safety training, and properly provision
fire-control equipment and fire extinguishers.
In addition, you should establish procedures to protect your equipment in the event of a
fire emergency. Juniper Networks products should be installed in an environment suitable
for electronic equipment. We recommend that fire suppression equipment be available
in the event of a fire in the vicinity of the equipment and that all local fire, safety, and
electrical codes and ordinances be observed when you install and operate your equipment.
Fire Suppression
In the event of an electrical hazard or an electrical fire, you should first turn power off to
the equipment at the source. Then use a Type C fire extinguisher, which uses noncorrosive
fire retardants, to extinguish the fire.

172

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 15: General Safety Information

Fire Suppression Equipment


Type C fire extinguishers, which use noncorrosive fire retardants such as carbon dioxide
and Halotron, are most effective for suppressing electrical fires. Type C fire extinguishers
displace oxygen from the point of combustion to eliminate the fire. For extinguishing fire
on or around equipment that draws air from the environment for cooling, you should use
this type of inert oxygen displacement extinguisher instead of an extinguisher that leaves
residues on equipment.
Do not use multipurpose Type ABC chemical fire extinguishers (dry chemical fire
extinguishers). The primary ingredient in these fire extinguishers is monoammonium
phosphate, which is very sticky and difficult to clean. In addition, in the presence of minute
amounts of moisture, monoammonium phosphate can become highly corrosive and
corrodes most metals.
Any equipment in a room in which a chemical fire extinguisher has been discharged is
subject to premature failure and unreliable operation. The equipment is considered to
be irreparably damaged.

NOTE: To keep warranties effective, do not use a dry chemical fire extinguisher
to control a fire at or near a Juniper Networks switch or other network device
provided by Juniper. If a dry chemical fire extinguisher is used, the unit is no
longer eligible for coverage under a service agreement.

We recommend that you dispose of any irreparably damaged equipment in an


environmentally responsible manner.
Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

Action to Take After an Electrical Accident on page 212

Qualified Personnel Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: Only trained and qualified personnel should install or replace the
device.
Waarschuwing Installatie en reparaties mogen uitsluitend door getraind en
bevoegd personeel uitgevoerd worden.
Varoitus Ainoastaan koulutettu ja ptev henkilkunta saa asentaa tai vaihtaa
tmn laitteen.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

173

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Attention Tout installation ou remplacement de l'appareil doit tre ralis


par du personnel qualifi et comptent.
Warnung Gert nur von geschultem, qualifiziertem Personal installieren oder
auswechseln lassen.
Avvertenza Solo personale addestrato e qualificato deve essere autorizzato
ad installare o sostituire questo apparecchio.
Advarsel Kun kvalifisert personell med riktig opplring br montere eller
bytte ut dette utstyret.
Aviso Este equipamento dever ser instalado ou substitudo apenas por
pessoal devidamente treinado e qualificado.
Atencin! Estos equipos deben ser instalados y reemplazados
exclusivamente por personal tcnico adecuadamente preparado y capacitado.
Varning! Denna utrustning ska endast installeras och bytas ut av utbildad
och kvalificerad personal.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 200

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

Warning Statement for Norway and Sweden


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: The equipment must be connected to an earthed mains


socket-outlet.
Advarsel Apparatet skal kobles til en jordet stikkontakt.
Varning! Apparaten skall anslutas till jordat ntuttag.

Related
Documentation

174

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 16

Radiation and Laser Warnings

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches on page 175

Radiation from Open Port Apertures Warning on page 178

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches
EX Series switches and the XRE200 External Routing Engine are equipped with laser
transmitters, which are considered a Class 1 Laser Product by the U.S. Food and Drug
Administration and are evaluated as a Class 1 Laser Product per EN 60825-1 requirements.
Observe the following guidelines and warnings:

General Laser Safety Guidelines on page 175

Class 1 Laser Product Warning on page 176

Class 1 LED Product Warning on page 176

Laser Beam Warning on page 177

General Laser Safety Guidelines


When working around ports that support optical transceivers, observe the following
safety guidelines to prevent eye injury:

Do not look into unterminated ports or at fibers that connect to unknown sources.

Do not examine unterminated optical ports with optical instruments.

Avoid direct exposure to the beam.

WARNING: Unterminated optical connectors can emit invisible laser


radiation. The lens in the human eye focuses all the laser power on the
retina, so focusing the eye directly on a laser sourceeven a low-power
lasercould permanently damage the eye.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

175

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Class 1 Laser Product Warning

WARNING: Class 1 laser product.


Waarschuwing Klasse-1 laser produkt.
Varoitus Luokan 1 lasertuote.
Attention Produit laser de classe I.
Warnung Laserprodukt der Klasse 1.

WARNING: Avvertenza Prodotto laser di Classe 1.


Advarsel Laserprodukt av klasse 1.
Aviso Produto laser de classe 1.
Atencin! Producto lser Clase I.
Varning! Laserprodukt av klass 1.

Class 1 LED Product Warning

WARNING: Class 1 LED product.


Waarschuwing Klasse 1 LED-product.
Varoitus Luokan 1 valodiodituote.
Attention Alarme de produit LED Class I.
Warnung Class 1 LED-Produktwarnung.

WARNING: Avvertenza Avvertenza prodotto LED di Classe 1.


Advarsel LED-produkt i klasse 1.
Aviso Produto de classe 1 com LED.
Atencin! Aviso sobre producto LED de Clase 1.
Varning! Lysdiodprodukt av klass 1.

176

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 16: Radiation and Laser Warnings

Laser Beam Warning


WARNING: Do not stare into the laser beam or view it directly with optical
instruments.

WARNING: Waarschuwing Niet in de straal staren of hem rechtstreeks


bekijken met optische instrumenten.

WARNING: Varoitus l katso steeseen lk tarkastele sit suoraan optisen


laitteen avulla.

WARNING: Attention Ne pas fixer le faisceau des yeux, ni l'observer


directement l'aide d'instruments optiques.

WARNING: Warnung Nicht direkt in den Strahl blicken und ihn nicht direkt
mit optischen Gerten prfen.

WARNING: Avvertenza Non fissare il raggio con gli occhi n usare strumenti
ottici per osservarlo direttamente.

WARNING: Advarsel Stirr eller se ikke direkte p strlen med optiske


instrumenter.

WARNING: Aviso No olhe fixamente para o raio, nem olhe para ele
directamente com instrumentos pticos.

WARNING: Atencin! No mirar fijamente el haz ni observarlo directamente


con instrumentos pticos.

WARNING: Varning! Rikta inte blicken in mot strlen och titta inte direkt p
den genom optiska instrument.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

177

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Radiation from Open Port Apertures Warning on page 178

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Pluggable Transceivers Supported on EX Series Switches

Radiation from Open Port Apertures Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: Because invisible radiation might be emitted from the aperture


of the port when no fiber cable is connected, avoid exposure to radiation and
do not stare into open apertures.
Waarschuwing Aangezien onzichtbare straling vanuit de opening van de
poort kan komen als er geen fiberkabel aangesloten is, dient blootstelling
aan straling en het kijken in open openingen vermeden te worden.
Varoitus Koska portin aukosta voi emittoitua nkymtnt steily, kun
kuitukaapelia ei ole kytkettyn, vlt steilylle altistumista lk katso
avoimiin aukkoihin.
Attention Des radiations invisibles l'il nu pouvant traverser l'ouverture du
port lorsqu'aucun cble en fibre optique n'y est connect, il est recommand
de ne pas regarder fixement l'intrieur de ces ouvertures.
Warnung Aus der Port-ffnung knnen unsichtbare Strahlen emittieren,
wenn kein Glasfaserkabel angeschlossen ist. Vermeiden Sie es, sich den
Strahlungen auszusetzen, und starren Sie nicht in die ffnungen!
Avvertenza Quando i cavi in fibra non sono inseriti, radiazioni invisibili possono
essere emesse attraverso l'apertura della porta. Evitate di esporvi alle
radiazioni e non guardate direttamente nelle aperture.
Advarsel Unng utsettelse for strling, og stirr ikke inn i pninger som er pne,
fordi usynlig strling kan emiteres fra portens pning nr det ikke er tilkoblet
en fiberkabel.
Aviso Dada a possibilidade de emisso de radiao invisvel atravs do orifcio
da via de acesso, quando esta no tiver nenhum cabo de fibra conectado,
dever evitar a exposio radiao e no dever olhar fixamente para
orifcios que se encontrarem a descoberto.

178

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 16: Radiation and Laser Warnings

Atencin! Debido a que la apertura del puerto puede emitir radiacin invisible
cuando no existe un cable de fibra conectado, evite mirar directamente a las
aperturas para no exponerse a la radiacin.
Varning! Osynlig strlning kan avges frn en portppning utan ansluten
fiberkabel och du br drfr undvika att bli utsatt fr strlning genom att inte
stirra in i oskyddade ppningar.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches on page 175

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for the QFX Series

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

179

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

180

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 17

Installation and Maintenance Safety


Information

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches on page 183

Ramp Warning on page 183

Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings on page 184

Wall-Mounting Warnings for EX2200 Switches on page 189

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Maintenance and Operational Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 190

Installation Instructions Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: Read the installation instructions before you connect the device
to a power source.
Waarschuwing Raadpleeg de installatie-aanwijzingen voordat u het systeem
met de voeding verbindt.
Varoitus Lue asennusohjeet ennen jrjestelmn yhdistmist virtalhteeseen.
Attention Avant de brancher le systme sur la source d'alimentation, consulter
les directives d'installation.
Warnung Lesen Sie die Installationsanweisungen, bevor Sie das System an
die Stromquelle anschlieen.
Avvertenza Consultare le istruzioni di installazione prima di collegare il sistema
all'alimentatore.
Advarsel Les installasjonsinstruksjonene fr systemet kobles til strmkilden.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

181

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Aviso Leia as instrues de instalao antes de ligar o sistema sua fonte


de energia.
Atencin! Ver las instrucciones de instalacin antes de conectar el sistema
a la red de alimentacin.
Varning! Ls installationsanvisningarna innan du kopplar systemet till dess
strmfrsrjningsenhet.

Related
Documentation

182

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches on page 175

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for the QFX Series

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting AC Power to an EX3200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX3300 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4300 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4500 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4550 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4600 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX6200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX8200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9204 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9208 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9214 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Connecting DC Power to an EX3200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4300 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4500 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4600 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4550 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX6200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX8200 Switch

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 17: Installation and Maintenance Safety Information

Connecting DC Power to an EX9204 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX9208 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX9214 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an XRE200 External Routing Engine

Connecting DC Power to an XRE200 External Routing Engine

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3100 Director Device

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device with Single-Phase Wiring


Trays

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device with Three-Phase Delta Wiring


Trays

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device with Three-Phase Wye Wiring


Trays

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3500, QFX3600, or QFX3600-I Device

Connecting DC Power to a QFX3500, QFX3600, or QFX3600-I Device

Connecting AC Power to a QFX5100 Switch

Connecting DC Power to a QFX5100 Switch

Chassis Lifting Guidelines for EX2200 Switches


Observe the following guidelines for lifting and moving an EX2200 switch:

Related
Documentation

Before installing the switch, read the guidelines in Site Preparation Checklist for EX2200
Switches on page 61 to verify that the intended site meets the specified power,
environmental, and clearance requirements.

Before lifting or moving the switch, disconnect all external cables.

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on page 88

Ramp Warning
This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

183

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

WARNING: When installing the device, do not use a ramp inclined at more
than 10 degrees.
Waarschuwing Gebruik een oprijplaat niet onder een hoek van meer dan 10
graden.
Varoitus l kyt sellaista kaltevaa pintaa, jonka kaltevuus ylitt 10 astetta.
Attention Ne pas utiliser une rampe dont l'inclinaison est suprieure 10
degrs.
Warnung Keine Rampen mit einer Neigung von mehr als 10 Grad verwenden.
Avvertenza Non usare una rampa con pendenza superiore a 10 gradi.
Advarsel Bruk aldri en rampe som heller mer enn 10 grader.
Aviso No utilize uma rampa com uma inclinao superior a 10 graus.
Atencin! No usar una rampa inclinada ms de 10 grados
Varning! Anvnd inte ramp med en lutning p mer n 10 grader.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Rack-Mounting and Cabinet-Mounting Warnings


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.
Ensure that the rack or cabinet in which the device is installed is evenly and securely
supported. Uneven mechanical loading could lead to a hazardous condition.

WARNING: To prevent bodily injury when mounting or servicing the device


in a rack, take the following precautions to ensure that the system remains
stable. The following directives help maintain your safety:

184

The device must be installed in a rack that is secured to the building


structure.

The device should be mounted at the bottom of the rack if it is the only unit
in the rack.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 17: Installation and Maintenance Safety Information

When mounting the device on a partially filled rack, load the rack from the
bottom to the top with the heaviest component at the bottom of the rack.

If the rack is provided with stabilizing equipment, install the stabilizers


before mounting or servicing the device in the rack.

Waarschuwing Om lichamelijk letsel te voorkomen wanneer u dit toestel in


een rek monteert of het daar een servicebeurt geeft, moet u speciale
voorzorgsmaatregelen nemen om ervoor te zorgen dat het toestel stabiel
blijft. De onderstaande richtlijnen worden verstrekt om uw veiligheid te
verzekeren:

De Juniper Networks switch moet in een stellage worden genstalleerd die


aan een bouwsel is verankerd.

Dit toestel dient onderaan in het rek gemonteerd te worden als het toestel
het enige in het rek is.

Wanneer u dit toestel in een gedeeltelijk gevuld rek monteert, dient u het
rek van onderen naar boven te laden met het zwaarste onderdeel onderaan
in het rek.

Als het rek voorzien is van stabiliseringshulpmiddelen, dient u de


stabilisatoren te monteren voordat u het toestel in het rek monteert of het
daar een servicebeurt geeft.

Varoitus Kun laite asetetaan telineeseen tai huolletaan sen ollessa telineess,
on noudatettava erityisi varotoimia jrjestelmn vakavuuden silyttmiseksi,
jotta vltytn loukkaantumiselta. Noudata seuraavia turvallisuusohjeita:

Juniper Networks switch on asennettava telineeseen, joka on kiinnitetty


rakennukseen.

Jos telineess ei ole muita laitteita, aseta laite telineen alaosaan.

Jos laite asetetaan osaksi tytettyyn telineeseen, aloita kuormittaminen


sen alaosasta kaikkein raskaimmalla esineell ja siirry sitten sen ylosaan.

Jos telinett varten on vakaimet, asenna ne ennen laitteen asettamista


telineeseen tai sen huoltamista siin.

Attention Pour viter toute blessure corporelle pendant les oprations de


montage ou de rparation de cette unit en casier, il convient de prendre des
prcautions spciales afin de maintenir la stabilit du systme. Les directives
ci-dessous sont destines assurer la protection du personnel:

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Le rack sur lequel est mont le Juniper Networks switch doit tre fix la
structure du btiment.

Si cette unit constitue la seule unit monte en casier, elle doit tre place
dans le bas.

185

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Si cette unit est monte dans un casier partiellement rempli, charger le


casier de bas en haut en plaant l'lment le plus lourd dans le bas.

Si le casier est quip de dispositifs stabilisateurs, installer les stabilisateurs


avant de monter ou de rparer l'unit en casier.

Warnung Zur Vermeidung von Krperverletzung beim Anbringen oder Warten


dieser Einheit in einem Gestell mssen Sie besondere Vorkehrungen treffen,
um sicherzustellen, da das System stabil bleibt. Die folgenden Richtlinien
sollen zur Gewhrleistung Ihrer Sicherheit dienen:

Der Juniper Networks switch mu in einem Gestell installiert werden, das


in der Gebudestruktur verankert ist.

Wenn diese Einheit die einzige im Gestell ist, sollte sie unten im Gestell
angebracht werden.

Bei Anbringung dieser Einheit in einem zum Teil gefllten Gestell ist das
Gestell von unten nach oben zu laden, wobei das schwerste Bauteil unten
im Gestell anzubringen ist.

Wird das Gestell mit Stabilisierungszubehr geliefert, sind zuerst die


Stabilisatoren zu installieren, bevor Sie die Einheit im Gestell anbringen
oder sie warten.

Avvertenza Per evitare infortuni fisici durante il montaggio o la manutenzione


di questa unit in un supporto, occorre osservare speciali precauzioni per
garantire che il sistema rimanga stabile. Le seguenti direttive vengono fornite
per garantire la sicurezza personale:

Il Juniper Networks switch deve essere installato in un telaio, il quale deve


essere fissato alla struttura dell'edificio.

Questa unit deve venire montata sul fondo del supporto, se si tratta
dell'unica unit da montare nel supporto.

Quando questa unit viene montata in un supporto parzialmente pieno,


caricare il supporto dal basso all'alto, con il componente pi pesante
sistemato sul fondo del supporto.

Se il supporto dotato di dispositivi stabilizzanti, installare tali dispositivi


prima di montare o di procedere alla manutenzione dell'unit nel supporto.

Advarsel Unng fysiske skader under montering eller reparasjonsarbeid p


denne enheten nr den befinner seg i et kabinett. Vr nye med at systemet
er stabilt. Flgende retningslinjer er gitt for verne om sikkerheten:

186

Juniper Networks switch m installeres i et stativ som er forankret til


bygningsstrukturen.

Denne enheten br monteres nederst i kabinettet hvis dette er den eneste


enheten i kabinettet.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 17: Installation and Maintenance Safety Information

Ved montering av denne enheten i et kabinett som er delvis fylt, skal


kabinettet lastes fra bunnen og opp med den tyngste komponenten nederst
i kabinettet.

Hvis kabinettet er utstyrt med stabiliseringsutstyr, skal stabilisatorene


installeres fr montering eller utfring av reparasjonsarbeid p enheten i
kabinettet.

Aviso Para se prevenir contra danos corporais ao montar ou reparar esta


unidade numa estante, dever tomar precaues especiais para se certificar
de que o sistema possui um suporte estvel. As seguintes directrizes
ajud-lo-o a efectuar o seu trabalho com segurana:

O Juniper Networks switch dever ser instalado numa prateleira fixa


estrutura do edificio.

Esta unidade dever ser montada na parte inferior da estante, caso seja
esta a nica unidade a ser montada.

Ao montar esta unidade numa estante parcialmente ocupada, coloque os


itens mais pesados na parte inferior da estante, arrumando-os de baixo
para cima.

Se a estante possuir um dispositivo de estabilizao, instale-o antes de


montar ou reparar a unidade.

Atencin! Para evitar lesiones durante el montaje de este equipo sobre un


bastidor, o posteriormente durante su mantenimiento, se debe poner mucho
cuidado en que el sistema quede bien estable. Para garantizar su seguridad,
proceda segn las siguientes instrucciones:

El Juniper Networks switch debe instalarse en un bastidor fijado a la


estructura del edificio.

Colocar el equipo en la parte inferior del bastidor, cuando sea la nica


unidad en el mismo.

Cuando este equipo se vaya a instalar en un bastidor parcialmente ocupado,


comenzar la instalacin desde la parte inferior hacia la superior colocando
el equipo ms pesado en la parte inferior.

Si el bastidor dispone de dispositivos estabilizadores, instalar stos antes


de montar o proceder al mantenimiento del equipo instalado en el bastidor.

Varning! Fr att undvika kroppsskada nr du installerar eller utfr


underhllsarbete p denna enhet p en stllning mste du vidta srskilda
frsiktighetstgrder fr att frskra dig om att systemet str stadigt. Fljande
riktlinjer ges fr att trygga din skerhet:

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

187

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Related
Documentation

188

Juniper Networks switch mste installeras i en stllning som r frankrad


i byggnadens struktur.

Om denna enhet r den enda enheten p stllningen skall den installeras


lngst ned p stllningen.

Om denna enhet installeras p en delvis fylld stllning skall stllningen


fyllas nedifrn och upp, med de tyngsta enheterna lngst ned p stllningen.

Om stllningen r frsedd med stabiliseringsdon skall dessa monteras fast


innan enheten installeras eller underhlls p stllningen.

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on page 88

Mounting an EX3200 Switch

Mounting an EX3300 Switch

Mounting an EX4200 Switch

Mounting an EX4300 Switch

Mounting an EX4500 Switch

Mounting an EX4550 Switch

Mounting an EX4600 Switch in a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting an EX6210 Switch on a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting an EX8208 Switch on a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting an EX8216 Switch on a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting an EX9200 Switch on a Rack or Cabinet Using a Mechanical Lift

Mounting an EX9204 Switch on a Rack or Cabinet Without Using a Mechanical Lift

Mounting an EX9208 Switch on a Rack or Cabinet Without Using a Mechanical Lift

Mounting a QFX3100 Director Device on Four Posts in a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting a QFX3100 Director Device on Two Posts in a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device on a Rack or Cabinet Using a Mechanical


Lift

Mounting a QFX3600 or QFX3600-I Device on Four Posts in a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting a QFX3600 or QFX3600-I Device on Two Posts in a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting a QFX3500 Device in a Rack or Cabinet

Mounting a QFX5100 Switch in a Rack or Cabinet

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 17: Installation and Maintenance Safety Information

Wall-Mounting Warnings for EX2200 Switches

WARNING:

Related
Documentation

When mounting an EX2200 switch chassis in a vertical position, orient the


front panel of the chassis downward to ensure proper airflow and meet
safety requirements in the event of a fire.

When wall mounting Power over Ethernet (PoE) models (EX2200-24P


and EX2200-48P), install the wall-mount baffle above the units to reduce
the risk of objects or substances falling into the air exhaust or power supply,
which could cause a fire.

Mounting an EX2200 Switch on a Wall on page 102

Grounded Equipment Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: The device is intended to be grounded. During normal use, ensure


that you have connected earth ground to the chassis.
Waarschuwing Deze apparatuur hoort geaard te worden Zorg dat de
host-computer tijdens normaal gebruik met aarde is verbonden.
Varoitus Tm laitteisto on tarkoitettu maadoitettavaksi. Varmista, ett
isntlaite on yhdistetty maahan normaalikytn aikana.
Attention Cet quipement doit tre reli la terre. S'assurer que l'appareil
hte est reli la terre lors de l'utilisation normale.
Warnung Dieses Gert mu geerdet werden. Stellen Sie sicher, da das
Host-Gert whrend des normalen Betriebs an Erde gelegt ist.
Avvertenza Questa apparecchiatura deve essere collegata a massa. Accertarsi
che il dispositivo host sia collegato alla massa di terra durante il normale
utilizzo.
Advarsel Dette utstyret skal jordes. Forviss deg om vertsterminalen er jordet
ved normalt bruk.
Aviso Este equipamento dever estar ligado terra. Certifique-se que o host
se encontra ligado terra durante a sua utilizao normal.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

189

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Atencin! Este equipo debe conectarse a tierra. Asegurarse de que el equipo


principal est conectado a tierra durante el uso normal.
Varning! Denna utrustning r avsedd att jordas. Se till att vrdenheten r
jordad vid normal anvndning.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

Maintenance and Operational Safety Guidelines and Warnings


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.
While performing the maintenance activities for devices, observe the following guidelines
and warnings:

Battery Handling Warning on page 190

Jewelry Removal Warning on page 191

Lightning Activity Warning on page 192

Operating Temperature Warning on page 193

Product Disposal Warning on page 194

Battery Handling Warning


WARNING: Replacing a battery incorrectly might result in an explosion.
Replace a battery only with the same or equivalent type recommended by
the manufacturer. Dispose of used batteries according to the manufacturer's
instructions.
Waarschuwing Er is ontploffingsgevaar als de batterij verkeerd vervangen
wordt. Vervang de batterij slechts met hetzelfde of een equivalent type dat
door de fabrikant aanbevolen is. Gebruikte batterijen dienen overeenkomstig
fabrieksvoorschriften weggeworpen te worden.
Varoitus Rjhdyksen vaara, jos akku on vaihdettu vrn akkuun. Kyt
vaihtamiseen ainoastaan saman- tai vastaavantyyppist akkua, joka on
valmistajan suosittelema. Hvit kytetyt akut valmistajan ohjeiden mukaan.
Attention Danger d'explosion si la pile n'est pas remplace correctement.
Ne la remplacer que par une pile de type semblable ou quivalent,
recommande par le fabricant. Jeter les piles usages conformment aux
instructions du fabricant.

190

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 17: Installation and Maintenance Safety Information

Warnung Bei Einsetzen einer falschen Batterie besteht Explosionsgefahr.


Ersetzen Sie die Batterie nur durch den gleichen oder vom Hersteller
empfohlenen Batterietyp. Entsorgen Sie die benutzten Batterien nach den
Anweisungen des Herstellers.
Advarsel Det kan vre fare for eksplosjon hvis batteriet skiftes p feil mte.
Skift kun med samme eller tilsvarende type som er anbefalt av produsenten.
Kasser brukte batterier i henhold til produsentens instruksjoner.
Avvertenza Pericolo di esplosione se la batteria non installata
correttamente. Sostituire solo con una di tipo uguale o equivalente, consigliata
dal produttore. Eliminare le batterie usate secondo le istruzioni del produttore.
Aviso Existe perigo de exploso se a bateria for substituda incorrectamente.
Substitua a bateria por uma bateria igual ou de um tipo equivalente
recomendado pelo fabricante. Destrua as baterias usadas conforme as
instrues do fabricante.
Atencin! Existe peligro de explosin si la batera se reemplaza de manera
incorrecta. Reemplazar la batera exclusivamente con el mismo tipo o el
equivalente recomendado por el fabricante. Desechar las bateras gastadas
segn las instrucciones del fabricante.
Varning! Explosionsfara vid felaktigt batteribyte. Erstt endast batteriet med
samma batterityp som rekommenderas av tillverkaren eller motsvarande.
Flj tillverkarens anvisningar vid kassering av anvnda batterier.

Jewelry Removal Warning


WARNING: Before working on equipment that is connected to power lines,
remove jewelry, including rings, necklaces, and watches. Metal objects heat
up when connected to power and ground and can cause serious burns or can
be welded to the terminals.
Waarschuwing Alvorens aan apparatuur te werken die met elektrische
leidingen is verbonden, sieraden (inclusief ringen, kettingen en horloges)
verwijderen. Metalen voorwerpen worden warm wanneer ze met stroom en
aarde zijn verbonden, en kunnen ernstige brandwonden veroorzaken of het
metalen voorwerp aan de aansluitklemmen lassen.
Varoitus Ennen kuin tyskentelet voimavirtajohtoihin kytkettyjen laitteiden
parissa, ota pois kaikki korut (sormukset, kaulakorut ja kellot mukaan lukien).
Metalliesineet kuumenevat, kun ne ovat yhteydess shkvirran ja maan
kanssa, ja ne voivat aiheuttaa vakavia palovammoja tai hitsata metalliesineet
kiinni liitntnapoihin.
Attention Avant d'accder cet quipement connect aux lignes lectriques,
ter tout bijou (anneaux, colliers et montres compris). Lorsqu'ils sont branchs

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

191

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

l'alimentation et relis la terre, les objets mtalliques chauffent, ce qui


peut provoquer des blessures graves ou souder l'objet mtallique aux bornes.
Warnung Vor der Arbeit an Gerten, die an das Netz angeschlossen sind,
jeglichen Schmuck (einschlielich Ringe, Ketten und Uhren) abnehmen.
Metallgegenstnde erhitzen sich, wenn sie an das Netz und die Erde
angeschlossen werden, und knnen schwere Verbrennungen verursachen
oder an die Anschluklemmen angeschweit werden.
Avvertenza Prima di intervenire su apparecchiature collegate alle linee di
alimentazione, togliersi qualsiasi monile (inclusi anelli, collane, braccialetti
ed orologi). Gli oggetti metallici si riscaldano quando sono collegati tra punti
di alimentazione e massa: possono causare ustioni gravi oppure il metallo
pu saldarsi ai terminali.
Advarsel Fjern alle smykker (inkludert ringer, halskjeder og klokker) fr du
skal arbeide p utstyr som er koblet til kraftledninger. Metallgjenstander som
er koblet til kraftledninger og jord blir svrt varme og kan forrsake alvorlige
brannskader eller smelte fast til polene.
Aviso Antes de trabalhar em equipamento que esteja ligado a linhas de
corrente, retire todas as jias que estiver a usar (incluindo anis, fios e
relgios). Os objectos metlicos aquecero em contacto com a corrente e
em contacto com a ligao terra, podendo causar queimaduras graves ou
ficarem soldados aos terminais.
Atencin! Antes de operar sobre equipos conectados a lneas de
alimentacin, quitarse las joyas (incluidos anillos, collares y relojes). Los
objetos de metal se calientan cuando se conectan a la alimentacin y a tierra,
lo que puede ocasionar quemaduras graves o que los objetos metlicos
queden soldados a los bornes.
Varning! Tag av alla smycken (inklusive ringar, halsband och armbandsur)
innan du arbetar p utrustning som r kopplad till kraftledningar. Metallobjekt
hettas upp nr de kopplas ihop med strm och jord och kan frorsaka
allvarliga brnnskador; metallobjekt kan ocks sammansvetsas med
kontakterna.

Lightning Activity Warning


WARNING: Do not work on the system or connect or disconnect cables during
periods of lightning activity.
Waarschuwing Tijdens onweer dat gepaard gaat met bliksem, dient u niet
aan het systeem te werken of kabels aan te sluiten of te ontkoppelen.
Varoitus l tyskentele jrjestelmn parissa lk yhdist tai irrota
kaapeleita ukkosilmalla.

192

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 17: Installation and Maintenance Safety Information

Attention Ne pas travailler sur le systme ni brancher ou dbrancher les


cbles pendant un orage.
Warnung Arbeiten Sie nicht am System und schlieen Sie keine Kabel an
bzw. trennen Sie keine ab, wenn es gewittert.
Avvertenza Non lavorare sul sistema o collegare oppure scollegare i cavi
durante un temporale con fulmini.
Advarsel Utfr aldri arbeid p systemet, eller koble kabler til eller fra systemet
nr det tordner eller lyner.
Aviso No trabalhe no sistema ou ligue e desligue cabos durante perodos
de mau tempo (trovoada).
Atencin! No operar el sistema ni conectar o desconectar cables durante el
transcurso de descargas elctricas en la atmsfera.
Varning! Vid ska skall du aldrig utfra arbete p systemet eller ansluta eller
koppla loss kablar.

Operating Temperature Warning


WARNING: To prevent the device from overheating, do not operate it in an
area that exceeds the maximum recommended ambient temperature of
104 F (40 C) for EX6200 switches, EX8208 switches, EX8216 switches,
QFX Series devices, and XRE200 External Routing Engines and 113 F (45 C)
for EX2200, EX3300, EX3200, EX4200, EX4300, EX4500, and EX4550
switches. To prevent airflow restriction, allow at least 6 in. (15.2 cm) of
clearance around the ventilation openings.
Waarschuwing Om te voorkomen dat welke switch van de Juniper Networks
router dan ook oververhit raakt, dient u deze niet te bedienen op een plaats
waar de maximale aanbevolen omgevingstemperatuur van 40 C wordt
overschreden. Om te voorkomen dat de luchtstroom wordt beperkt, dient er
minstens 15,2 cm speling rond de ventilatie-openingen te zijn.
Varoitus Ettei Juniper Networks switch-sarjan reititin ylikuumentuisi, sit ei
saa kytt tilassa, jonka lmptila ylitt korkeimman suositellun
ympristlmptilan 40 C. Ettei ilmanvaihto estyisi, tuuletusaukkojen
ymprille on jtettv ainakin 15,2 cm tilaa.
Attention Pour viter toute surchauffe des routeurs de la gamme Juniper
Networks switch, ne l'utilisez pas dans une zone o la temprature ambiante
est suprieure 40 C. Pour permettre un flot d'air constant, dgagez un
espace d'au moins 15,2 cm autour des ouvertures de ventilations.
Warnung Um einen Router der switch vor berhitzung zu schtzen, darf dieser
nicht in einer Gegend betrieben werden, in der die Umgebungstemperatur

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

193

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

das empfohlene Maximum von 40 C berschreitet. Um Lftungsverschlu


zu verhindern, achten Sie darauf, da mindestens 15,2 cm lichter Raum um
die Lftungsffnungen herum frei bleibt.
Avvertenza Per evitare il surriscaldamento dei switch, non adoperateli in un
locale che ecceda la temperatura ambientale massima di 40 C. Per evitare
che la circolazione dell'aria sia impedita, lasciate uno spazio di almeno 15.2 cm
di fronte alle aperture delle ventole.
Advarsel Unng overoppheting av eventuelle rutere i Juniper Networks switch
Disse skal ikke brukes p steder der den anbefalte maksimale
omgivelsestemperaturen overstiger 40 C (104 F). Srg for at klaringen
rundt luftepningene er minst 15,2 cm (6 tommer) for forhindre nedsatt
luftsirkulasjon.
Aviso Para evitar o sobreaquecimento do encaminhador Juniper Networks
switch, no utilize este equipamento numa rea que exceda a temperatura
mxima recomendada de 40 C. Para evitar a restrio circulao de ar,
deixe pelo menos um espao de 15,2 cm volta das aberturas de ventilao.
Atencin! Para impedir que un encaminador de la serie Juniper Networks
switch se recaliente, no lo haga funcionar en un rea en la que se supere la
temperatura ambiente mxima recomendada de 40 C. Para impedir la
restriccin de la entrada de aire, deje un espacio mnimo de 15,2 cm alrededor
de las aperturas para ventilacin.
Varning! Frhindra att en Juniper Networks switch verhettas genom att inte
anvnda den i ett omrde dr den maximalt rekommenderade
omgivningstemperaturen p 40 C verskrids. Frhindra att luftcirkulationen
inskrnks genom att se till att det finns fritt utrymme p minst 15,2 cm omkring
ventilationsppningarna.

Product Disposal Warning


WARNING: Disposal of this device must be handled according to all national
laws and regulations.
Waarschuwing Dit produkt dient volgens alle landelijke wetten en
voorschriften te worden afgedankt.
Varoitus Tmn tuotteen lopullisesta hvittmisest tulee huolehtia kaikkia
valtakunnallisia lakeja ja snnksi noudattaen.
Attention La mise au rebut dfinitive de ce produit doit tre effectue
conformment toutes les lois et rglementations en vigueur.
Warnung Dieses Produkt mu den geltenden Gesetzen und Vorschriften
entsprechend entsorgt werden.

194

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 17: Installation and Maintenance Safety Information

Avvertenza L'eliminazione finale di questo prodotto deve essere eseguita


osservando le normative italiane vigenti in materia
Advarsel Endelig disponering av dette produktet m skje i henhold til nasjonale
lover og forskrifter.
Aviso A descartagem final deste produto dever ser efectuada de acordo
com os regulamentos e a legislao nacional.
Atencin! El desecho final de este producto debe realizarse segn todas las
leyes y regulaciones nacionales
Varning! Slutlig kassering av denna produkt br sktas i enlighet med landets
alla lagar och freskrifter.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 200

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for EX Series Switches on page 175

Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings for the QFX Series

Installation Instructions Warning on page 181

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

195

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

196

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 18

Power and Electrical Safety Information

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

Prevention of Electrostatic Discharge Damage on page 198

AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 200

AC Power Disconnection Warning on page 202

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

DC Power Disconnection Warning on page 205

DC Power Grounding Requirements and Warning on page 207

DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning on page 208

DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning on page 209

TN Power Warning on page 211

Action to Take After an Electrical Accident on page 212

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: Certain ports on the device are designed for use as intrabuilding
(within-the-building) interfaces only (Type 2 or Type 4 ports as described in
GR-1089-CORE) and require isolation from the exposed outside plant (OSP)
cabling. To comply with NEBS requirements and protect against lightning
surges and commercial power disturbances, the intrabuilding ports must not
be metallically connected to interfaces that connect to the OSP or its wiring.
The intrabuilding ports on the device are suitable for connection to
intrabuilding or unexposed wiring or cabling only. The addition of primary
protectors is not sufficient protection for connecting these interfaces
metallically to OSP wiring.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

197

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

CAUTION: Before removing or installing components of a device, attach an


electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to an ESD point and place the
other end of the strap around your bare wrist. Failure to use an ESD grounding
strap could result in damage to the switch.

Install the device in compliance with the following local, national, and international
electrical codes:

United StatesNational Fire Protection Association (NFPA 70), United States


National Electrical Code.

Other countriesInternational Electromechanical Commission (IEC) 60364, Part 1


through Part 7.

Evaluated to the TN power system.

CanadaCanadian Electrical Code, Part 1, CSA C22.1.

Locate the emergency power-off switch for the room in which you are working so that
if an electrical accident occurs, you can quickly turn off the power.

Make sure that grounding surfaces are cleaned and brought to a bright finish before
grounding connections are made.

Do not work alone if potentially hazardous conditions exist anywhere in your workspace.

Never assume that power is disconnected from a circuit. Always check the circuit before
starting to work.

Carefully look for possible hazards in your work area, such as moist floors, ungrounded
power extension cords, and missing safety grounds.

Operate the device within marked electrical ratings and product usage instructions.

To ensure that the device and peripheral equipment function safely and correctly, use
the cables and connectors specified for the attached peripheral equipment, and make
certain they are in good condition.

You can remove and replace many device components without powering off or
disconnecting power to the device, as detailed elsewhere in the hardware documentation
for this device. Never install an equipment that it appears to be damaged.
Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 200

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

Prevention of Electrostatic Discharge Damage


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.

198

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 18: Power and Electrical Safety Information

This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.


Device components that are shipped in antistatic bags are sensitive to damage from
static electricity. Some components can be impaired by voltages as low as 30 V. You
can easily generate potentially damaging static voltages whenever you handle plastic
or foam packing material or if you move components across plastic or carpets. Observe
the following guidelines to minimize the potential for electrostatic discharge (ESD)
damage, which can cause intermittent or complete component failures:

Always use an ESD grounding strap when you are handling components that are subject
to ESD damage, and make sure that it is in direct contact with your skin.
If a grounding strap is not available, hold the component in its antistatic bag (see
Figure 60 on page 199) in one hand and touch the exposed, bare metal of the device
with the other hand immediately before inserting the component into the device.

WARNING: For safety, periodically check the resistance value of the ESD
grounding strap. The measurement must be in the range 1 through
10 Mohms.

When handling any component that is subject to ESD damage and that is removed
from the device, make sure the equipment end of your ESD grounding strap is attached
to the ESD point on the chassis.
If no grounding strap is available, touch the exposed, bare metal of the device to ground
yourself before handling the component.

Avoid contact between the component that is subject to ESD damage and your clothing.
ESD voltages emitted from clothing can damage components.

When removing or installing a component that is subject to ESD damage, always place
it component-side up on an antistatic surface, in an antistatic card rack, or in an
antistatic bag (see Figure 60 on page 199). If you are returning a component, place it in
an antistatic bag before packing it.

Figure 60: Place a Component into an Antistatic Bag

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

199

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

CAUTION: ANSI/TIA/EIA-568 cables such as Category 5e and Category 6


can get electrostatically charged. To dissipate this charge, always ground
the cables to a suitable and safe earth ground before connecting them to the
system.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

See EX2200 Switches Hardware Overview on page 3 for the ESD point location.

See Rear Panel of an EX3200 Switch for the ESD point location.

See Rear Panel of an EX3300 Switch for the ESD point location.

See Rear Panel of an EX4200 Switch for the ESD point location.

See EX4300 Switches Hardware Overview for the ESD point location.

See Front Panel of an EX4500 Switch for the ESD point location.

See EX4550 Switches Hardware Overview for the ESD point location.

See Chassis Physical Specifications of an EX6210 Switch for the ESD point location.

See Chassis Physical Specifications of an EX8208 Switch for the ESD point location.

See Chassis Physical Specifications of an EX8216 Switch for the ESD point location.

See EX9204 Switch Hardware Overview for the ESD point location.

See EX9208 Switch Hardware Overview for the ESD point location.

See EX9214 Switch Hardware Overview for the ESD point location.

See QFX3008-I Interconnect Device Overview for the ESD point location.

See Front Panel of a QFX3500 Device for the ESD point location.

See Front Panel of a QFX3600 Device for the ESD point location.

See Physical Description of a Redundant Power System

See Port Panel of an EX4600 Switch for the ESD point location.

See Port Panel of a QFX5100-48S Switch for the ESD point location.

See Port Panel of a QFX5100-24Q Switch for the ESD point location.

Port Panel of a QFX5100-96S Device for the ESD point location.

AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

200

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 18: Power and Electrical Safety Information

CAUTION: For devices with AC power supplies, an external surge protective


device (SPD) must be used at the AC power source.

The following electrical safety guidelines apply to AC-powered devices:

Note the following warnings printed on the device:


CAUTION: THIS UNIT HAS MORE THAN ONE POWER SUPPLY CORD. DISCONNECT
ALL POWER SUPPLY CORDS BEFORE SERVICING TO AVOID ELECTRIC SHOCK.
ATTENTION: CET APPAREIL COMPORTE PLUS D'UN CORDON D'ALIMENTATION.
AFIN DE PRVENIR LES CHOCS LECTRIQUES, DBRANCHER TOUT CORDON
D'ALIMENTATION AVANT DE FAIRE LE DPANNAGE.

AC-powered devices are shipped with a three-wire electrical cord with a grounding-type
plug that fits only a grounding-type power outlet. Do not circumvent this safety feature.
Equipment grounding must comply with local and national electrical codes.

You must provide an external certified circuit breaker rated minimum 20 A in the building
installation.

The power cord serves as the main disconnecting device for the AC-powered device.
The socket outlet must be near the AC-powered device and be easily accessible.

For devices that have more than one power supply connection, you must ensure that
all power connections are fully disconnected so that power to the device is completely
removed to prevent electric shock. To disconnect power, unplug all power cords (one
for each power supply).

Power Cable Warning (Japanese)


WARNING: The attached power cable is only for this product. Do not use the cable for another product.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

Multiple Power Supplies Disconnection Warning

Connecting AC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 123

Connecting AC Power to an EX3200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX3300 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4200 Switch

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

201

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Connecting AC Power to an EX4300 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4500 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4550 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX4600 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX6200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX8200 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9204 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9208 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an EX9214 Switch

Connecting AC Power to an XRE200 External Routing Engine

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3100 Director Device

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device with Single-Phase Wiring


Trays

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device with Three-Phase Delta Wiring


Trays

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3008-I Interconnect Device with Three-Phase Wye Wiring


Trays

Connecting AC Power to a QFX3500, QFX3600, or QFX3600-I Device

Connecting AC Power to a QFX5100 Switch

AC Power Disconnection Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: Before working on the switch or near power supplies, unplug all
the power cords from an AC switch.
Waarschuwing Voordat u aan een frame of in de nabijheid van voedingen
werkt, dient u bij wisselstroom toestellen de stekker van het netsnoer uit het
stopcontact te halen.
Varoitus Kytke irti vaihtovirtalaitteiden virtajohto, ennen kuin teet mitn
asennuspohjalle tai tyskentelet virtalhteiden lheisyydess.
Attention Avant de travailler sur un chssis ou proximit d'une alimentation
lectrique, dbrancher le cordon d'alimentation des units en courant
alternatif.

202

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 18: Power and Electrical Safety Information

Warnung Bevor Sie an einem Chassis oder in der Nhe von Netzgerten
arbeiten, ziehen Sie bei Wechselstromeinheiten das Netzkabel ab bzw.
Avvertenza Prima di lavorare su un telaio o intorno ad alimentatori, scollegare
il cavo di alimentazione sulle unit CA.
Advarsel Fr det utfres arbeid p kabinettet eller det arbeides i nrheten
av strmforsyningsenheter, skal strmledningen trekkes ut p
vekselstrmsenheter.
Aviso Antes de trabalhar num chassis, ou antes de trabalhar perto de unidades
de fornecimento de energia, desligue o cabo de alimentao nas unidades
de corrente alternada.
Atencin! Antes de manipular el chasis de un equipo o trabajar cerca de una
fuente de alimentacin, desenchufar el cable de alimentacin en los equipos
de corriente alterna (CA).
Varning! Innan du arbetar med ett chassi eller nra strmfrsrjningsenheter
skall du fr vxelstrmsenheter dra ur ntsladden.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 200

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches and the XRE200 External Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

203

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

A DC-powered device is equipped with a DC terminal block that is rated for the power
requirements of a maximally configured device.

NOTE: To supply sufficient power, terminate the DC input wiring on a facility


DC source that is capable of supplying:

Minimum of 7.5 A at 48 VDC for EX2200 and EX3300 switches

Minimum of 8 A at 48 VDC for EX3200 and EX4200 switches

Minimum of 50 A at 48 VDC for EX6210 switches

Minimum of 60 A at 48 VDC for EX8208 switches

Minimum of 100 A at 48 VDC for EX8216 switches

Minimum of 7 A at 48 VDC for QFX3500, EX4600, and QFX5100 devices

Minimum of 8 A at 48 VDC for QFX3600 devices

Incorporate an easily accessible disconnect device into the facility wiring. Be sure to
connect the ground wire or conduit to a solid office earth ground. A closed loop ring is
recommended for terminating the ground conductor at the ground stud.

Run two wires from the circuit breaker box to a source of 48 VDC.

A DC-powered device that is equipped with a DC terminal block is intended only for
installation in a restricted access location. In the United States, a restricted access
area is one in accordance with Articles 110-16, 110-17, and 110-18 of the National Electrical
Code ANSI/NFPA 70.

NOTE: Primary overcurrent protection is provided by the building circuit


breaker. This breaker must protect against excess currents, short circuits,
and earth grounding faults in accordance with NEC ANSI/NFPA 70.

Related
Documentation

204

Ensure that the polarity of the DC input wiring is correct. Under certain conditions,
connections with reversed polarity might trip the primary circuit breaker or damage
the equipment.

For personal safety, connect the green and yellow wire to safety (earth) ground at both
the device and the supply side of the DC wiring.

The marked input voltage of 48 VDC for a DC-powered device is the nominal voltage
associated with the battery circuit, and any higher voltages are only to be associated
with float voltages for the charging function.

Because the device is a positive ground system, you must connect the positive lead to
the terminal labeled RTN, the negative lead to the terminal labeled 48 VDC, and the
earth ground to the device grounding points.

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 18: Power and Electrical Safety Information

DC Power Disconnection Warning on page 205

DC Power Grounding Requirements and Warning on page 207

DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning on page 208

DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning on page 209

Connecting DC Power to an EX2200 Switch on page 125

Connecting DC Power to an EX3200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4300 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4500 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4550 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX4600 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX6200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX8200 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX9204 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX9208 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an EX9214 Switch

Connecting DC Power to an XRE200 External Routing Engine

Connecting DC Power to a QFX3500, QFX3600, or QFX3600-I Device

Connecting DC Power to a QFX5100 Switch

DC Power Disconnection Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches and the XRE200 External Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: Before performing any of the DC power procedures, ensure that


power is removed from the DC circuit. To ensure that all power is off, locate
the circuit breaker on the panel board that services the DC circuit, switch the
circuit breaker to the OFF position, and tape the device handle of the circuit
breaker in the OFF position.
Waarschuwing Voordat u een van de onderstaande procedures uitvoert,
dient u te controleren of de stroom naar het gelijkstroom circuit uitgeschakeld
is. Om u ervan te verzekeren dat alle stroom UIT is geschakeld, kiest u op het
schakelbord de stroomverbreker die het gelijkstroom circuit bedient, draait
de stroomverbreker naar de UIT positie en plakt de schakelaarhendel van de
stroomverbreker met plakband in de UIT positie vast.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

205

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Varoitus Varmista, ett tasavirtapiiriss ei ole virtaa ennen seuraavien


toimenpiteiden suorittamista. Varmistaaksesi, ett virta on KATKAISTU
tysin, paikanna tasavirrasta huolehtivassa kojetaulussa sijaitseva suojakytkin,
knn suojakytkin KATKAISTU-asentoon ja teippaa suojakytkimen varsi
niin, ett se pysyy KATKAISTU-asennossa.
Attention Avant de pratiquer l'une quelconque des procdures ci-dessous,
vrifier que le circuit en courant continu n'est plus sous tension. Pour en tre
sr, localiser le disjoncteur situ sur le panneau de service du circuit en courant
continu, placer le disjoncteur en position ferme (OFF) et, l'aide d'un ruban
adhsif, bloquer la poigne du disjoncteur en position OFF.
Warnung Vor Ausfhrung der folgenden Vorgnge ist sicherzustellen, da
die Gleichstromschaltung keinen Strom erhlt. Um sicherzustellen, da
smtlicher Strom abgestellt ist, machen Sie auf der Schalttafel den
Unterbrecher fr die Gleichstromschaltung ausfindig, stellen Sie den
Unterbrecher auf AUS, und kleben Sie den Schaltergriff des Unterbrechers
mit Klebeband in der AUS-Stellung fest.
Avvertenza Prima di svolgere una qualsiasi delle procedure seguenti, verificare
che il circuito CC non sia alimentato. Per verificare che tutta l'alimentazione
sia scollegata (OFF), individuare l'interruttore automatico sul quadro
strumenti che alimenta il circuito CC, mettere l'interruttore in posizione OFF
e fissarlo con nastro adesivo in tale posizione.
Advarsel Fr noen av disse prosedyrene utfres, kontroller at strmmen er
frakoblet likestrmkretsen. Srg for at all strm er sltt AV. Dette gjres ved
lokalisere strmbryteren p brytertavlen som betjener likestrmkretsen,
sl strmbryteren AV og teipe bryterhndtaket p strmbryteren i AV-stilling.
Aviso Antes de executar um dos seguintes procedimentos, certifique-se que
desligou a fonte de alimentao de energia do circuito de corrente contnua.
Para se assegurar que toda a corrente foi DESLIGADA, localize o disjuntor no
painel que serve o circuito de corrente contnua e coloque-o na posio OFF
(Desligado), segurando nessa posio a manivela do interruptor do disjuntor
com fita isoladora.
Atencin! Antes de proceder con los siguientes pasos, comprobar que la
alimentacin del circuito de corriente continua (CC) est cortada (OFF). Para
asegurarse de que toda la alimentacin est cortada (OFF), localizar el
interruptor automtico en el panel que alimenta al circuito de corriente
continua, cambiar el interruptor automtico a la posicin de Apagado (OFF),
y sujetar con cinta la palanca del interruptor automtico en posicin de
Apagado (OFF).
Varning! Innan du utfr ngon av fljande procedurer mste du kontrollera
att strmfrsrjningen till likstrmskretsen r bruten. Kontrollera att all
strmfrsrjning r BRUTEN genom att sl AV det verspnningsskydd som
skyddar likstrmskretsen och tejpa fast verspnningsskyddets omkopplare
i FRN-lget.

206

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 18: Power and Electrical Safety Information

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

DC Power Grounding Requirements and Warning on page 207

DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning on page 208

DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning on page 209

DC Power Grounding Requirements and Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches and the XRE200 External Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.
An insulated grounding conductor that is identical in size to the grounded and ungrounded
branch circuit supply conductors but is identifiable by green and yellow stripes is installed
as part of the branch circuit that supplies the device. The grounding conductor is a
separately derived system at the supply transformer or motor generator set.

WARNING: When you install the device, the ground connection must always
be made first and disconnected last.
Waarschuwing Bij de installatie van het toestel moet de aardverbinding altijd
het eerste worden gemaakt en het laatste worden losgemaakt.
Varoitus Laitetta asennettaessa on maahan yhdistminen aina tehtv
ensiksi ja maadoituksen irti kytkeminen viimeiseksi.
Attention Lors de l'installation de l'appareil, la mise la terre doit toujours
tre connecte en premier et dconnecte en dernier.
Warnung Der Erdanschlu mu bei der Installation der Einheit immer zuerst
hergestellt und zuletzt abgetrennt werden.
Avvertenza In fase di installazione dell'unit, eseguire sempre per primo il
collegamento a massa e disconnetterlo per ultimo.
Advarsel Nr enheten installeres, m jordledningen alltid tilkobles frst og
frakobles sist.
Aviso Ao instalar a unidade, a ligao terra dever ser sempre a primeira a
ser ligada, e a ltima a ser desligada.
Atencin! Al instalar el equipo, conectar la tierra la primera y desconectarla
la ltima.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

207

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Varning! Vid installation av enheten mste jordledningen alltid anslutas frst


och kopplas bort sist.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

DC Power Disconnection Warning on page 205

DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning on page 208

DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning on page 209

DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches and the XRE200 External Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: Wire the DC power supply using the appropriate lugs. When
connecting power, the proper wiring sequence is ground to ground, +RTN to
+RTN, then 48 V to 48 V. When disconnecting power, the proper wiring
sequence is 48 V to 48 V, +RTN to +RTN, then ground to ground. Note
that the ground wire must always be connected first and disconnected last.
Waarschuwing De juiste bedradingsvolgorde verbonden is aarde naar aarde,
+RTN naar +RTN, en 48 V naar 48 V. De juiste bedradingsvolgorde
losgemaakt is en 48 naar 48 V, +RTN naar +RTN, aarde naar aarde.
Varoitus Oikea yhdistettava kytkentajarjestys on maajohto maajohtoon,
+RTN varten +RTN, 48 V varten 48 V. Oikea irrotettava kytkentajarjestys
on 48 V varten 48 V, +RTN varten +RTN, maajohto maajohtoon.
Attention Cblez l'approvisionnement d'alimentation CC En utilisant les
crochets appropris l'extrmit de cblage. En reliant la puissance, l'ordre
appropri de cblage est rectifi pour rectifier, +RTN +RTN, puis 48 V
48 V. En dbranchant la puissance, l'ordre appropri de cblage est 48 V
48 V, +RTN +RTN, a alors rectifi pour rectifier. Notez que le fil de masse
devrait toujours tre reli d'abord et dbranch pour la dernire fois. Notez
que le fil de masse devrait toujours tre reli d'abord et dbranch pour la
dernire fois.
Warnung Die Stromzufuhr ist nur mit geeigneten Ringsen an das DC Netzteil
anzuschliessen. Die richtige Anschlusssequenz ist: Erdanschluss zu
Erdanschluss, +RTN zu +RTN und dann -48V zu -48V. Die richtige Sequenz
zum Abtrennen der Stromversorgung ist -48V zu -48V, +RTN zu +RTN und

208

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 18: Power and Electrical Safety Information

dann Erdanschluss zu Erdanschluss. Es ist zu beachten dass der Erdanschluss


immer zuerst angeschlossen und als letztes abgetrennt wird.
Avvertenza Mostra la morsettiera dell alimentatore CC. Cablare l'alimentatore
CC usando i connettori adatti all'estremit del cablaggio, come illustrato. La
corretta sequenza di cablaggio da massa a massa, da positivo a positivo
(da linea ad L) e da negativo a negativo (da neutro a N). Tenere presente che
il filo di massa deve sempre venire collegato per primo e scollegato per ultimo.
Advarsel Riktig tilkoples tilkoplingssekvens er jord til jord, +RTN til +RTN,
48 V til 48 V. Riktig frakoples tilkoplingssekvens er 48 V til 48 V, +RTN
til +RTN, jord til jord.
Aviso Ate con alambre la fuente de potencia cc Usando los terminales
apropiados en el extremo del cableado. Al conectar potencia, la secuencia
apropiada del cableado se muele para moler, +RTN a +RTN, entonces 48 V
a 48 V. Al desconectar potencia, la secuencia apropiada del cableado es
48 V a 48 V, +RTN a +RTN, entonces moli para moler. Observe que el
alambre de tierra se debe conectar siempre primero y desconectar por ltimo.
Observe que el alambre de tierra se debe conectar siempre primero y
desconectar por ltimo.
Atencin! Wire a fonte de alimentao de DC Usando os tales apropriados
na extremidade da fiao. Ao conectar a potncia, a seqncia apropriada
da fiao moda para moer, +RTN a +RTN, ento 48 V a 48 V. Ao
desconectar a potncia, a seqncia apropriada da fiao 48 V a 48 V,
+RTN a +RTN, moeu ento para moer. Anote que o fio terra deve sempre
ser conectado primeiramente e desconectado por ltimo. Anote que o fio
terra deve sempre ser conectado primeiramente e desconectado por ltimo.
Varning! Korrekt kopplingssekvens ar jord till jord, +RTN till +RTN, 48 V till
48 V. Korrekt kopplas kopplingssekvens ar 48 V till 48 V, +RTN till +RTN,
jord till jord.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

DC Power Disconnection Warning on page 205

DC Power Grounding Requirements and Warning on page 207

DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning on page 209

DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches and the XRE200 External Routing Engine.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

209

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: When stranded wiring is required, use approved wiring


terminations, such as closed-loop or spade-type with upturned lugs. These
terminations must be the appropriate size for the wires and must clamp both
the insulation and conductor.
Waarschuwing Wanneer geslagen bedrading vereist is, dient u bedrading te
gebruiken die voorzien is van goedgekeurde aansluitingspunten, zoals het
gesloten-lus type of het grijperschop type waarbij de aansluitpunten omhoog
wijzen. Deze aansluitpunten dienen de juiste maat voor de draden te hebben
en dienen zowel de isolatie als de geleider vast te klemmen.
Varoitus Jos sikeellinen johdin on tarpeen, kyt hyvksytty johdinliitnt,
esimerkiksi suljettua silmukkaa tai kourumaista liitnt, jossa on ylspin
knnetyt kiinnityskorvat. Tllaisten liitntjen tulee olla kooltaan johtimiin
sopivia ja niiden tulee puristaa yhteen sek eristeen ett johdinosan.
Attention Quand des fils torsads sont ncessaires, utiliser des douilles
terminales homologues telles que celles circuit ferm ou du type plage
ouverte avec cosses rebrousses. Ces douilles terminales doivent tre de la
taille qui convient aux fils et doivent tre refermes sur la gaine isolante et
sur le conducteur.
Warnung Wenn Litzenverdrahtung erforderlich ist, sind zugelassene
Verdrahtungsabschlsse, z.B. fr einen geschlossenen Regelkreis oder
gabelfrmig, mit nach oben gerichteten Kabelschuhen zu verwenden. Diese
Abschlsse sollten die angemessene Gre fr die Drhte haben und sowohl
die Isolierung als auch den Leiter festklemmen.
Avvertenza Quando occorre usare trecce, usare connettori omologati, come
quelli a occhiello o a forcella con linguette rivolte verso l'alto. I connettori
devono avere la misura adatta per il cablaggio e devono serrare sia l'isolante
che il conduttore.
Advarsel Hvis det er ndvendig med flertrdede ledninger, brukes godkjente
ledningsavslutninger, som for eksempel lukket slyfe eller spadetype med
oppoverbyde kabelsko. Disse avslutningene skal ha riktig strrelse i forhold
til ledningene, og skal klemme sammen bde isolasjonen og lederen.
Aviso Quando forem requeridas montagens de instalao elctrica de cabo
torcido, use terminaes de cabo aprovadas, tais como, terminaes de cabo
em circuito fechado e planas com terminais de orelha voltados para cima.
Estas terminaes de cabo devero ser do tamanho apropriado para os
respectivos cabos, e devero prender simultaneamente o isolamento e o fio
condutor.
Atencin! Cuando se necesite hilo trenzado, utilizar terminales para cables
homologados, tales como las de tipo "bucle cerrado" o "espada", con las
lengetas de conexin vueltas hacia arriba. Estos terminales debern ser del

210

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 18: Power and Electrical Safety Information

tamao apropiado para los cables que se utilicen, y tendrn que sujetar tanto
el aislante como el conductor.
Varning! Nr flertrdiga ledningar krvs mste godknda ledningskontakter
anvndas, t.ex. kabelsko av sluten eller ppen typ med upptvnd tapp.
Storleken p dessa kontakter mste vara avpassad till ledningarna och mste
kunna hlla bde isoleringen och ledaren fastklmda.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

DC Power Disconnection Warning on page 205

DC Power Grounding Requirements and Warning on page 207

DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning on page 208

TN Power Warning
This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.

WARNING: The device is designed to work with a TN power system.


Waarschuwing Het apparaat is ontworpen om te functioneren met TN
energiesystemen.
Varoitus Koje on suunniteltu toimimaan TN-shkvoimajrjestelmien
yhteydess.
Attention Ce dispositif a t conu pour fonctionner avec des systmes
d'alimentation TN.
Warnung Das Gert ist fr die Verwendung mit TN-Stromsystemen ausgelegt.
Avvertenza Il dispositivo stato progettato per l'uso con sistemi di
alimentazione TN.
Advarsel Utstyret er utfomet til bruk med TN-strmsystemer.
Aviso O dispositivo foi criado para operar com sistemas de corrente TN.
Atencin! El equipo est diseado para trabajar con sistemas de
alimentacin tipo TN.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

211

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Varning! Enheten r konstruerad fr anvndning tillsammans med


elkraftssystem av TN-typ.

Related
Documentation

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

Grounded Equipment Warning on page 189

Multiple Power Supplies Disconnection Warning

Action to Take After an Electrical Accident


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic also applies to hardware devices in the QFX Series.
If an electrical accident results in an injury, take the following actions in this order:
1.

Use caution. Be aware of potentially hazardous conditions that could cause further
injury.

2. Disconnect power from the device.


3. If possible, send another person to get medical aid. Otherwise, assess the condition

of the victim, then call for help.


Related
Documentation

212

General Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 169

General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings on page 197

AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 200

DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines on page 203

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

PART 8

Compliance Information

Compliance Information on page 215

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

213

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

214

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

CHAPTER 19

Compliance Information

Agency Approvals for EX Series Switches on page 215

Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for EX Series Switches on page 216

Compliance Statements for Acoustic Noise for EX Series Switches on page 219

Declaration of Conformity for EX2200 Switches on page 221

Agency Approvals for EX Series Switches


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
These hardware devices comply with the following standards:

Safety

CAN/CSA-C22.2 No. 60950-1 Information Technology Equipment

UL 60950-1 Information Technology Equipment

EN 60950-1 Information Technology Equipment

IEC 60950-1 Information Technology Equipment

EN 60825-1 Safety of Laser Products - Part 1: Equipment classification and


requirements

EMC

FCC 47CFR Part 15 Class A (USA)

EN 55022 Class A Emissions (Europe)

ICES-003 Class A

VCCI Class A (Japan)

AS/NZS CISPR 22 Class A (Australia/New Zealand)

CISPR 22 Class A

EN 55024

EN 300386

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

215

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Related
Documentation

EN 61000-3-2 Power Line Harmonics

EN 61000-3-3 Voltage Fluctuations and Flicker

EN 61000-4-2 ESD

EN 61000-4-3 Radiated Immunity

EN 61000-4-4 EFT

EN 61000-4-5 Surge

EN 61000-4-6 Low Frequency Common Immunity

EN 61000-4-11 Voltage Dips and Sags

Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for EX Series Switches on page 216

Compliance Statements for Acoustic Noise for EX Series Switches on page 219

Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for EX Series Switches


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.
This topic describes the EMC requirements for these hardware devices for:

Canada on page 216

European Community on page 217

Israel on page 217

Japan on page 217

Korea on page 218

United States on page 218

FCC Part 15 Statement on page 218

Nonregulatory Environmental Standards on page 219

Canada
This Class A digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.
Cet appareil numrique de la classe A est conforme la norme NMB-003 du Canada.
The Industry Canada label identifies certified equipment. This certification means that
the equipment meets certain telecommunications network protective, operational, and
safety requirements. Industry Canada does not guarantee the equipment will operate to
the users satisfaction.
Before installing this equipment, users should ensure that it is permissible to connect the
equipment to the facilities of the local telecommunications company. The equipment
must also be installed using an acceptable method of connection. In some cases, the
inside wiring associated with a single line individual service can be extended by means

216

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 19: Compliance Information

of a certified connector assembly. The customer should be aware that compliance with
the above conditions might not prevent degradation of service in some situations.
Repairs to certified equipment should be made by an authorized Canadian maintenance
facility designated by the supplier. Any repairs or alterations made by the user to this
equipment, or equipment malfunctions, might give the telecommunications company
cause to request the user to disconnect the equipment.

CAUTION: Users should not attempt to make electrical ground connections


by themselves, but should contact the appropriate inspection authority or
an electrician, as appropriate.

Users should ensure for their own protection that the electrical ground connections of
the power utility, telephone lines, and internal metallic water pipe system, if present, are
connected together. This precaution might be particularly important in rural areas.

European Community
This is a Class A device. In a domestic environment this device might cause radio
interference, in which case the user needs to take adequate measures.

Israel

Translation from HebrewWarning: This product is Class A. In residential environments,


the product may cause radio interference, and in such a situation, the user may be required
to take adequate measures.

Japan

The preceding translates as follows:


This is a Class A device. In a domestic environment this device might cause radio
interference, in which case the user needs to take adequate measures.
VCCI-A

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

217

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Korean Class A Warning

g040913

Korea

The preceding translates as follows:


This equipment is Industrial (Class A) electromagnetic wave suitability equipment and
seller or user should take notice of it, and this equipment is to be used in the places except
for home

United States
The device has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital
device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide
reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in
a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual,
might cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment
in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference, in which case users need to
correct the interference at their own expense.

FCC Part 15 Statement


This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital
device pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide
reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This
equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed
and used in accordance with the instructions, might cause harmful interference to radio
communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a
particular installation.
If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which
can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try
and correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:

218

Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.

Increase the separation between the equipment and the receiver.

Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the
receiver is connected.

Consult the dealer or an experienced radio or TV technician for help.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 19: Compliance Information

Nonregulatory Environmental Standards


NEBS complianceThese EX Series switches are Network Equipment Building System
(NEBS) compliant:

EX2200-24T and EX2200-48T

EX3200-24T, EX3200-48T

EX3300-24T, EX3300-48T

EX4200-24F, EX4200-24T, and EX4200-48T

EX4300-24T, EX4300-24P, EX4300-48T, EX4300-48T-AFI, and EX4300-48P

All EX4500 switches with AC power supplies

EX4550-32T-AFO, EX4550-32T-AFI, EX4550-32F-AFO, and EX4550-32F-AFI

EX4600-40F

All EX6200 switches

NOTE: For the EX6200-48P line cards, the intra-building ports must use
shielded intra-building cabling or wiring that is grounded at both ends.

All EX8200 switches

Those switch switches meet the following NEBS compliance standards:

Related
Documentation

SR-3580 NEBS Criteria Levels (Level 3 Compliance)

GR-1089-CORE: EMC and Electrical Safety for Network Telecommunications Equipment

GR-63-CORE: NEBS, Physical Protection

The equipment is suitable for installation as part of the Common Bonding Network
(CBN).

The equipment is suitable for installation in locations where the National Electrical
Code (NEC) applies.

The battery return connection is to be treated as an Isolated DC return (DC-I), as


defined in GR-1089-CORE.

Agency Approvals for EX Series Switches on page 215

Compliance Statements for Acoustic Noise for EX Series Switches on page 219

Compliance Statements for Acoustic Noise for EX Series Switches


This topic applies to hardware devices in the EX Series product family, which includes
switches, the EX Series Redundant Power System (RPS), and the XRE200 External
Routing Engine.

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

219

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Maschinenlrminformations-Verordnung - 3. GPSGV, der hchste Schalldruckpegel


betrgt 70 dB(A) oder weniger gemss EN ISO 7779
Translation:
The emitted sound pressure is below 70 dB(A) per EN ISO 7779.
Related
Documentation

220

Agency Approvals for EX Series Switches on page 215

Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for EX Series Switches on page 216

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

Chapter 19: Compliance Information

Declaration of Conformity for EX2200 Switches

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

221

Complete Hardware Guide for EX2200 Ethernet Switches

Related
Documentation

222

Agency Approvals for EX Series Switches on page 215

Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for EX Series Switches on page 216

Compliance Statements for Acoustic Noise for EX Series Switches on page 219

Copyright 2014, Juniper Networks, Inc.

You might also like